gnu: emacs-debbugs: Update to 0.9.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
CommitLineData
568717fd
LC
1\input texinfo
2@c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4@c %**start of header
5@setfilename guix.info
6@documentencoding UTF-8
f8348b91 7@settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
568717fd
LC
8@c %**end of header
9
10@include version.texi
7df7a74e
NK
11
12@copying
db5a9444 13Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016 Ludovic Courtès@*
af8a56b8 14Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014 Andreas Enge@*
87eafdbd 15Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
8c01b9d0
ML
16Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Mathieu Lirzin@*
17Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
97d76250
LF
18Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
19Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Leo Famulari
7df7a74e
NK
20
21Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
22under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
23any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
24Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
25copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
26Documentation License''.
27@end copying
568717fd 28
eeaf4427 29@dircategory Package management
568717fd
LC
30@direntry
31* guix: (guix). Guix, the functional package manager.
e49951eb 32* guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package
eeaf4427 33 Managing packages with Guix.
e49951eb 34* guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build
568717fd 35 Building packages with Guix.
054e8576
LC
36* guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system
37 Managing the operating system configuration.
568717fd 38@end direntry
568717fd 39
372c4bbc
DT
40@dircategory Software development
41@direntry
42* guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment
43 Building development environments with Guix.
44@end direntry
45
568717fd 46@titlepage
7730d112
LC
47@title GNU Guix Reference Manual
48@subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
2cbed07e 49@author The GNU Guix Developers
568717fd
LC
50
51@page
52@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
53Edition @value{EDITION} @*
54@value{UPDATED} @*
55
7df7a74e 56@insertcopying
568717fd
LC
57@end titlepage
58
568717fd
LC
59@contents
60
61@c *********************************************************************
62@node Top
f8348b91 63@top GNU Guix
568717fd 64
f8348b91
LC
65This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
66package management tool written for the GNU system.
568717fd
LC
67
68@menu
69* Introduction:: What is Guix about?
bd5e766b 70* Installation:: Installing Guix.
eeaf4427 71* Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
c554de89 72* Emacs Interface:: Using Guix from Emacs.
568717fd
LC
73* Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
74* Utilities:: Package management commands.
a1ba8475 75* GNU Distribution:: Software for your friendly GNU system.
9bf3c1a7 76* Contributing:: Your help needed!
568717fd
LC
77
78* Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
79* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
80* Concept Index:: Concepts.
a85b83d2 81* Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
aaa3eaa9
LC
82
83@detailmenu
84 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
85
86Installation
87
1b2b8177 88* Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
aaa3eaa9 89* Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
ec0339cd 90* Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
aaa3eaa9
LC
91* Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
92* Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
0e2d0213 93* Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
aaa3eaa9
LC
94
95Setting Up the Daemon
96
97* Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
98* Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
99
100Package Management
101
102* Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
103* Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
aaa3eaa9
LC
104* Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
105* Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
106* Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
107* Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
108* Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
109
c554de89
AK
110Emacs Interface
111
112* Initial Setup: Emacs Initial Setup. Preparing @file{~/.emacs}.
113* Package Management: Emacs Package Management. Managing packages and generations.
687c9bc0 114* Licenses: Emacs Licenses. Interface for licenses of Guix packages.
9b0afb0d 115* Popup Interface: Emacs Popup Interface. Magit-like interface for guix commands.
c554de89 116* Prettify Mode: Emacs Prettify. Abbreviating @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}} file names.
34850cd5 117* Build Log Mode: Emacs Build Log. Highlighting Guix build logs.
187f80c6
AK
118* Completions: Emacs Completions. Completing @command{guix} shell command.
119* Development: Emacs Development. Tools for Guix developers.
32950fc8 120* Hydra: Emacs Hydra. Interface for Guix build farm.
c554de89 121
aaa3eaa9
LC
122Programming Interface
123
124* Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
125* Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
126* The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
127* Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
128* The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
129* G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
130
92492b23
LC
131Defining Packages
132
133* package Reference:: The package data type.
134* origin Reference:: The origin data type.
135
aaa3eaa9
LC
136Utilities
137
138* Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
fcc58db6 139* Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
aaa3eaa9
LC
140* Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
141* Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
142* Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
143* Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
144* Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
fcc58db6 145* Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
88856916 146* Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
aaa3eaa9 147* Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
aff8ce7c 148* Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
d23c20f1 149* Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
32efa254 150* Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
aaa3eaa9
LC
151
152GNU Distribution
153
154* System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
35ed9306 155* System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
aaa3eaa9
LC
156* Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
157* Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
158* Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
159* Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
160* Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
161* Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
162
163System Configuration
164
165* Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
166* operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
167* File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
168* Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
169* User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
598e19dc 170* Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
aaa3eaa9
LC
171* Services:: Specifying system services.
172* Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
1b2b8177 173* X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
996ed739 174* Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
aaa3eaa9
LC
175* Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
176* GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
177* Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
97d76250 178* Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
aaa3eaa9
LC
179* Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
180
181Services
182
183* Base Services:: Essential system services.
184* Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
185* X Window:: Graphical display.
1b2b8177
LC
186* Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
187* Database Services:: SQL databases.
d8c18af8 188* Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
cbd02397 189* Web Services:: Web servers.
aa4ed923 190* Various Services:: Other services.
aaa3eaa9 191
0adfe95a
LC
192Defining Services
193
194* Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
195* Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
196* Service Reference:: API reference.
dd17bc38 197* Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
0adfe95a 198
aaa3eaa9
LC
199Packaging Guidelines
200
ec0339cd
LC
201* Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
202* Package Naming:: What's in a name?
203* Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
cbd02397 204* Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
ec0339cd
LC
205* Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
206* Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
207* Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
aaa3eaa9 208
8c01b9d0
ML
209Contributing
210
211* Building from Git:: The latest and greatest.
212* Running Guix Before It Is Installed:: Hacker tricks.
213* The Perfect Setup:: The right tools.
214* Coding Style:: Hygiene of the contributor.
215* Submitting Patches:: Share your work.
216
217Coding Style
218
219* Programming Paradigm:: How to compose your elements.
220* Modules:: Where to store your code?
221* Data Types and Pattern Matching:: Implementing data structures.
222* Formatting Code:: Writing conventions.
223
aaa3eaa9 224@end detailmenu
568717fd
LC
225@end menu
226
227@c *********************************************************************
228@node Introduction
229@chapter Introduction
230
c80e7e55
LC
231GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
232using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a functional
233package management tool for the GNU system. Package management consists
4bfc4ea3
NK
234of all activities that relate to building packages from sources,
235honoring their build-time and run-time dependencies,
c80e7e55
LC
236installing packages in user environments, upgrading installed packages
237to new versions or rolling back to a previous set, removing unused
238software packages, etc.
568717fd
LC
239
240@cindex functional package management
241The term @dfn{functional} refers to a specific package management
136787cb
LC
242discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
243In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
4bfc4ea3
NK
244as a function, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
245such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
246returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
568717fd
LC
247solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
248scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
4bfc4ea3
NK
249always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
250cannot alter the system's environment in
568717fd
LC
251any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
252of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
e900c503 253build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
4bfc4ea3 254explicit inputs are visible.
568717fd 255
e531ac2a 256@cindex store
568717fd 257The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
e531ac2a
LC
258system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
259Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own, in the
834129e0 260store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
568717fd
LC
261a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
262input yields a different directory name.
263
264This approach is the foundation of Guix's salient features: support for
4bfc4ea3 265transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
eeaf4427 266garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
568717fd 267
4bfc4ea3 268Guix has a command-line interface, which allows users to build, install,
568717fd 269upgrade, and remove packages, as well as a Scheme programming interface.
568717fd 270
3ca2731c 271@cindex Guix System Distribution
4705641f 272@cindex GuixSD
a1ba8475 273Last but not least, Guix is used to build a distribution of the GNU
3ca2731c 274system, with many GNU and non-GNU free software packages. The Guix
4705641f
LC
275System Distribution, or GNU@tie{}GuixSD, takes advantage of the core
276properties of Guix at the system level. With GuixSD, users
3ca2731c
LC
277@emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system configuration, and
278Guix takes care of instantiating that configuration in a reproducible,
279stateless fashion. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
a1ba8475 280
bd5e766b
LC
281@c *********************************************************************
282@node Installation
283@chapter Installation
284
48febeb8
LC
285GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
286@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}. This section describes the
287software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it and get
288ready to use it.
bd5e766b 289
5af6de3e
LC
290Note that this section is concerned with the installation of the package
291manager, which can be done on top of a running GNU/Linux system. If,
292instead, you want to install the complete GNU operating system,
6621cdb6 293@pxref{System Installation}.
5af6de3e 294
bd5e766b 295@menu
09722b11 296* Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
bd5e766b 297* Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
ec0339cd 298* Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
bd5e766b
LC
299* Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
300* Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
0e2d0213 301* Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
bd5e766b
LC
302@end menu
303
09722b11
LC
304@node Binary Installation
305@section Binary Installation
306
307This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
308self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
309dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
310is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
311GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
312
313Installing goes along these lines:
314
315@enumerate
316@item
317Download the binary tarball from
daa8922a
LC
318@indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
319where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
320already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
321
322Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
323authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
324
325@example
326$ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
327$ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
328@end example
329
330If that command fails because you don't have the required public key,
331then run this command to import it:
332
333@example
334$ gpg --keyserver keys.gnupg.net --recv-keys 3D9AEBB5
335@end example
336
337@noindent
338and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
09722b11
LC
339
340@item
341As @code{root}, run:
342
343@example
5dc42964 344# cd /tmp
254b1c2e
LC
345# tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
346 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
5dc42964 347# mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
09722b11
LC
348@end example
349
7acd3439
LC
350This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
351The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
352step.)
09722b11 353
5dc3ce5f
LC
354Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
355would overwrite its own essential files.
356
254b1c2e 357The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
e9ba6357
LC
358not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
359warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
360versions are fine.)
361They stem from the fact that all the
254b1c2e
LC
362files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
363means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
364archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
365reproducible.
366
7acd3439
LC
367@item
368Make @code{root}'s profile available under @file{~/.guix-profile}:
369
370@example
371# ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile \
372 ~root/.guix-profile
373@end example
374
43c33047
LC
375@item
376Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
377(@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
378
09722b11 379@item
175ced41 380Run the daemon:
09722b11
LC
381
382@example
7acd3439 383# ~root/.guix-profile/bin/guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
09722b11
LC
384@end example
385
d2825c96
LC
386On hosts using the systemd init system, drop
387@file{~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service} in
388@file{/etc/systemd/system}.
389
ad227484
MDRS
390Likewise, on hosts using the Upstart init system, drop
391@file{~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf} in
392@file{/etc/init}.
393
09722b11
LC
394@item
395Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
396for instance with:
397
398@example
399# mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
400# cd /usr/local/bin
d72d05f9 401# ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/bin/guix
09722b11 402@end example
39f8ed14 403
aca738f3
LC
404It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
405there:
406
407@example
408# mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
409# cd /usr/local/share/info
410# for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/share/info/* ;
411 do ln -s $i ; done
412@end example
413
414That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
415running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
416Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
417Info search path.)
418
39f8ed14
LC
419@item
420To use substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Substitutes}),
421authorize them:
422
423@example
7acd3439 424# guix archive --authorize < ~root/.guix-profile/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
39f8ed14 425@end example
09722b11
LC
426@end enumerate
427
53de532f
LC
428And that's it! For additional tips and tricks, @pxref{Application
429Setup}.
09722b11 430
5dc3ce5f 431The @code{guix} package must remain available in @code{root}'s
09722b11
LC
432profile, or it would become subject to garbage collection---in which
433case you would find yourself badly handicapped by the lack of the
434@command{guix} command.
435
39f8ed14
LC
436The tarball in question can be (re)produced and verified simply by
437running the following command in the Guix source tree:
09722b11
LC
438
439@example
440make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
441@end example
442
443
bd5e766b
LC
444@node Requirements
445@section Requirements
446
09722b11
LC
447This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
448build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
449not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
450in the Guix source tree for additional details.
451
bd5e766b
LC
452GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
453
454@itemize
47c66da0 455@item @url{http://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.0.7 or later;
288dca55 456@item @url{http://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
f0b98b84 457@item @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
8a96bd4b
ID
458@end itemize
459
460The following dependencies are optional:
461
462@itemize
288dca55 463@item
8a96bd4b 464Installing
288dca55 465@url{http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} will
2f7d2d91
LC
466allow you to use the @command{guix import pypi} command (@pxref{Invoking
467guix import}). It is of
288dca55 468interest primarily for developers and not for casual users.
8a96bd4b
ID
469@item
470Installing @uref{http://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS-Guile} will
471allow you to access @code{https} URLs with the @command{guix download}
d45dc6da
EB
472command (@pxref{Invoking guix download}), the @command{guix import pypi}
473command, and the @command{guix import cpan} command. This is primarily
474of interest to developers. @xref{Guile Preparations, how to install the
475GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile}.
bd5e766b
LC
476@end itemize
477
478Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
479following packages are also needed:
480
481@itemize
368d08f7
LC
482@item @url{http://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
483@item @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2};
484@item @url{http://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
485C++11 standard.
bd5e766b
LC
486@end itemize
487
4bfc4ea3
NK
488When a working installation of @url{http://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
489manager} is available, you
bd5e766b 490can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
4bfc4ea3 491Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
bd5e766b 492
b22a12fd
LC
493Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
494between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
495same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
4bfc4ea3
NK
496@code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
497specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
834129e0 498located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
b22a12fd 499@code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
4bfc4ea3
NK
500Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
501your goal is to share the store with Nix.
b22a12fd 502
ec0339cd
LC
503@node Running the Test Suite
504@section Running the Test Suite
505
506After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
507idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
508environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
509failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
510suite, type:
511
512@example
513make check
514@end example
515
516Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
517GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
518on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
519that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
520cache.
521
a887fd8d
LC
522It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
523@code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
524
525@example
526make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
527@end example
528
ec0339cd
LC
529Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
530@file{test-suite.log} file. When @file{tests/@var{something}.scm}
531fails, please also attach the @file{@var{something}.log} file available
532in the top-level build directory. Please specify the Guix version being
533used as well as version numbers of the dependencies
534(@pxref{Requirements}) in your message.
535
bd5e766b
LC
536@node Setting Up the Daemon
537@section Setting Up the Daemon
538
539@cindex daemon
540Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
49e6291a 541are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
bd5e766b
LC
542behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
543associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
544goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
e49951eb 545@command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
bd5e766b
LC
546daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
547
49e6291a 548The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
225dafde
LC
549environment. Also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
550the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
49e6291a
LC
551
552@menu
553* Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
554* Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
555@end menu
556
557@node Build Environment Setup
558@subsection Build Environment Setup
559
bd5e766b
LC
560In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
561@command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
834129e0 562administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
bd5e766b
LC
563@command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
564Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
565daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
566consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
567
568@cindex build users
569When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
570build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
571security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
572should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
573These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
574just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
575processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
576distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
577do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
578regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
579
580On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
581Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
582
091196b3
LC
583@c See http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
584@c for why `-G' is needed.
bd5e766b 585@example
cfc149dc
LC
586# groupadd --system guixbuild
587# for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
bd5e766b 588 do
cfc149dc
LC
589 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
590 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
591 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
592 guixbuilder$i;
bd5e766b
LC
593 done
594@end example
595
596@noindent
54eb03ab
LC
597The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
598parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
d2825c96
LC
599(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). The
600@code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
601following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
602dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
603file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
ad227484
MDRS
604@command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
605machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
606@file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
607file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
bd5e766b
LC
608
609@example
cfc149dc 610# guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
bd5e766b
LC
611@end example
612
e900c503 613@cindex chroot
b095792f
LC
614@noindent
615This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
cfc149dc 616the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
6dc99317
LC
617environment contains nothing but:
618
619@c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
620@itemize
621@item
4743a4da
LC
622a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
623host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
624that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
625can only be created if the host has them.};
626
627@item
628the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the container's processes
629since a separate PID name space is used;
6dc99317
LC
630
631@item
632@file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
633user @file{nobody};
634
635@item
636@file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
637
638@item
639@file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
640@code{127.0.0.1};
641
642@item
643a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
644@end itemize
b095792f 645
cb960102
ED
646You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
647@i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
7a57c96a 648within the chroot is always @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
cb960102
ED
649where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
650This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
651environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
652capture the name of their build tree.
653
e0c941fe
LC
654@vindex http_proxy
655The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
656HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
657(@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
658
1e2644bb
LC
659If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
660to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
661However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
662from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
663each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
664available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
665@emph{pure} functions.
bd5e766b 666
49e6291a
LC
667
668@node Daemon Offload Setup
669@subsection Using the Offload Facility
670
671@cindex offloading
4ec2e92d
LC
672@cindex build hook
673When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload}
674derivation builds to other machines
49e6291a
LC
675running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build hook}. When that
676feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
677@file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; anytime a build is requested, for
678instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
679of the machines that satisfies the derivation's constraints, in
680particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
681prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
682which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
683build are copied back to the initial machine.
684
4ec2e92d 685The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
49e6291a
LC
686
687@example
688(list (build-machine
689 (name "eightysix.example.org")
690 (system "x86_64-linux")
691 (user "bob")
692 (speed 2.)) ; incredibly fast!
693
694 (build-machine
695 (name "meeps.example.org")
696 (system "mips64el-linux")
697 (user "alice")
698 (private-key
699 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
c4fdfd6f 700 "/.lsh/identity-for-guix"))))
49e6291a
LC
701@end example
702
703@noindent
704In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
705the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
4ec2e92d
LC
706architecture.
707
708In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
709evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
710must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
711shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
712DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
713local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
c678a4ee
LC
714Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
715detailed below.
4ec2e92d 716
c678a4ee
LC
717@deftp {Data Type} build-machine
718This data type represents build machines the daemon may offload builds
719to. The important fields are:
49e6291a
LC
720
721@table @code
722
723@item name
724The remote machine's host name.
725
726@item system
c678a4ee 727The remote machine's system type---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
49e6291a
LC
728
729@item user
730The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
731Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
732allow non-interactive logins.
733
734@end table
735
4ec2e92d 736A number of optional fields may be specified:
49e6291a
LC
737
738@table @code
739
cecd72d5
LC
740@item port
741Port number of the machine's SSH server (default: 22).
742
49e6291a
LC
743@item private-key
744The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine.
745
c4fdfd6f
LC
746Currently offloading uses GNU@tie{}lsh as its SSH client
747(@pxref{Invoking lsh,,, GNU lsh Manual}). Thus, the key file here must
748be an lsh key file. This may change in the future, though.
749
49e6291a
LC
750@item parallel-builds
751The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine (1 by
752default.)
753
754@item speed
755A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
756machines with a higher speed factor.
757
758@item features
759A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
760An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
761and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
762name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
763
764@end table
c678a4ee 765@end deftp
49e6291a
LC
766
767The @code{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
768machines, since offloading works by invoking the @code{guix archive} and
c4fdfd6f
LC
769@code{guix build} commands. In addition, the Guix modules must be in
770@code{$GUILE_LOAD_PATH} on the build machine---you can check whether
771this is the case by running:
772
773@example
74273b6f 774lsh build-machine guile -c "'(use-modules (guix config))'"
c4fdfd6f 775@end example
49e6291a
LC
776
777There's one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
778explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
c4fdfd6f
LC
779between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
780generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
781archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
49e6291a
LC
782
783@example
784# guix archive --generate-key
785@end example
786
787@noindent
c4fdfd6f
LC
788Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
789it accepts store items it receives from the master:
790
791@example
792# guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
793@end example
794
795@noindent
796Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
797
798All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
799relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
800the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
801build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
802with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
49e6291a
LC
803
804
bd5e766b
LC
805@node Invoking guix-daemon
806@section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
807
808The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
809access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
810garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
811is normally run as @code{root} like this:
812
813@example
cfc149dc 814# guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
bd5e766b
LC
815@end example
816
817@noindent
081145cf 818For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
bd5e766b 819
e900c503
LC
820@cindex chroot
821@cindex container, build environment
822@cindex build environment
823@cindex reproducible builds
bd5e766b
LC
824By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
825different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
826@code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
827chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
828build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
829(@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
830system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
e900c503
LC
831@file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
832@dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
833a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
834etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
bd5e766b 835
cbc538fe
LC
836When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
837build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
838its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable; this directory is shared with
839the container for the duration of the build. Be aware that using a
840directory other than @file{/tmp} can affect build results---for example,
841with a longer directory name, a build process that uses Unix-domain
842sockets might hit the name length limitation for @code{sun_path}, which
843it would otherwise not hit.
844
845The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
846build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
847(@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
848
bd5e766b
LC
849The following command-line options are supported:
850
851@table @code
852@item --build-users-group=@var{group}
853Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
854the Daemon, build users}).
855
6858f9d1 856@item --no-substitutes
b5385b52 857@cindex substitutes
6858f9d1 858Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
c4202d60
LC
859locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
860(@pxref{Substitutes}).
6858f9d1 861
b5385b52
LC
862By default substitutes are used, unless the client---such as the
863@command{guix package} command---is explicitly invoked with
864@code{--no-substitutes}.
865
866When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
867explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
868remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
869
9176607e 870@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
f8a8e0fe 871@anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
9176607e 872Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
ae806096 873source URLs. When this option is omitted, @indicateurl{http://hydra.gnu.org}
9176607e
LC
874is used.
875
876This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
877as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
878
4ec2e92d
LC
879@cindex build hook
880@item --no-build-hook
881Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
882
883The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
884which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
885builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
886
bd5e766b
LC
887@item --cache-failures
888Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
889
30d9aa54
LC
890When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
891to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
892--clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
893@xref{Invoking guix gc}.
894
bd5e766b
LC
895@item --cores=@var{n}
896@itemx -c @var{n}
897Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
898as available.
899
6efc160e 900The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
e49951eb
MW
901as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
902guix build}).
bd5e766b
LC
903
904The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
905in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
906parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
907
908@item --max-jobs=@var{n}
909@itemx -M @var{n}
910Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
f6526eb3
LC
911@code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
912locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
913Setup}), or simply fail.
bd5e766b 914
ecf84b7c
LC
915@item --rounds=@var{N}
916Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
917consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
918setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
919(@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
920
bd5e766b
LC
921@item --debug
922Produce debugging output.
923
924This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
925overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
e49951eb 926@command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
bd5e766b
LC
927
928@item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
929Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
930
931Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
932they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
933and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
934Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
935needs.
936
937@item --disable-chroot
938Disable chroot builds.
939
940Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1e2644bb
LC
941processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
942though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
943account.
bd5e766b
LC
944
945@item --disable-log-compression
946Disable compression of the build logs.
947
1da983b9
LC
948Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
949@var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
950them with bzip2 by default. This option disables that.
951
ab3893d7
LC
952@item --disable-deduplication
953@cindex deduplication
bd5e766b
LC
954Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
955
1da983b9 956By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
ab3893d7
LC
957if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
958the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
4988dd40 959noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
ab3893d7
LC
960input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
961this optimization.
1da983b9 962
6e37066e
LC
963@item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
964Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
965derivations.
966
967When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
968available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
969meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are GC roots.
970
971@item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
972Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
973corresponding to live outputs.
974
975When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
976derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
977outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
978items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
979
980Note that when both @code{--gc-keep-derivations} and
981@code{--gc-keep-outputs} are used, the effect is to keep all the build
982prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time
983tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of whether these
984prerequisites are live. This is convenient for developers since it
985saves rebuilds or downloads.
986
bd5e766b
LC
987@item --impersonate-linux-2.6
988On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
989kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
990
991This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
992on the kernel version number.
993
994@item --lose-logs
995Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
ce33631f 996@code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
bd5e766b
LC
997
998@item --system=@var{system}
999Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1000architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1001@code{x86_64-linux}.
b8d2aa26
LC
1002
1003@item --listen=@var{socket}
1004Listen for connections on @var{socket}, the file name of a Unix-domain
1005socket. The default socket is
1006@file{@var{localstatedir}/daemon-socket/socket}. This option is only
1007useful in exceptional circumstances, such as if you need to run several
1008daemons on the same machine.
bd5e766b
LC
1009@end table
1010
1011
0e2d0213
LC
1012@node Application Setup
1013@section Application Setup
1014
85e57214
LC
1015When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than GuixSD---a
1016so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1017get everything in place. Here are some of them.
0e2d0213
LC
1018
1019@subsection Locales
1020
5c3c1427 1021@anchor{locales-and-locpath}
0e2d0213 1022@cindex locales, when not on GuixSD
5c3c1427 1023@vindex LOCPATH
85e57214 1024@vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
0e2d0213
LC
1025Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the host system's locale
1026data. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
85e57214
LC
1027available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1028variable:
0e2d0213
LC
1029
1030@example
1031$ guix package -i glibc-locales
85e57214 1032$ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
0e2d0213
LC
1033@end example
1034
1035Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1036locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1037110@tie{}MiB. Alternately, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1038limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1039
85e57214
LC
1040The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1041(@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1042Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1043
1044@enumerate
1045@item
1046@code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by Guix's libc, and not by the libc
1047provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
f9b9a033 1048to make sure the foreign distro's programs will not end up loading
85e57214
LC
1049incompatible locale data.
1050
1051@item
1052libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1053@code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1054should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1055different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1056data in the right format.
1057@end enumerate
1058
1059This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1060versions may be incompatible.
1061
0e2d0213
LC
1062@subsection X11 Fonts
1063
4988dd40 1064The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
0e2d0213
LC
1065load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. Guix's
1066@code{fontconfig} package looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1067by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1068to display fonts, you will have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1069Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
8fe5b1d1 1070@code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
0e2d0213 1071
5c36edc8
LC
1072To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1073graphical applications, consider installing
1074@code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1075has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1076Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1077for Chinese languages:
1078
1079@example
1080guix package -i font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1081@end example
1082
6d97319c
AK
1083@subsection Emacs Packages
1084
1085When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1086either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1087sub-directories of
1088@file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1089directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1090packages and storing all their files in a single directory may be not
1091reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1092directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1093the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1094Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1095
1096By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1097are placed, so you don't need to perform any configuration. If, for
1098some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1099with Guix, you can do it by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1100option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1101
0e2d0213
LC
1102@c TODO What else?
1103
eeaf4427
LC
1104@c *********************************************************************
1105@node Package Management
1106@chapter Package Management
1107
f8348b91 1108The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
eeaf4427
LC
1109remove software packages, without having to know about their build
1110procedure or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
1111features.
1112
1113This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the package
c1941588 1114management tools it provides. Two user interfaces are provided for
c554de89
AK
1115routine package management tasks: A command-line interface described below
1116(@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix package}}), as well as a visual user
1117interface in Emacs described in a subsequent chapter (@pxref{Emacs Interface}).
eeaf4427
LC
1118
1119@menu
1120* Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
e49951eb 1121* Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
c4202d60 1122* Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
760c60d6 1123* Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
e49951eb 1124* Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
f651b477 1125* Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
760c60d6 1126* Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
eeaf4427
LC
1127@end menu
1128
1129@node Features
1130@section Features
1131
1132When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
1133own directory---something that resembles
9a130e19
AK
1134@file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string
1135(note that Guix comes with an Emacs extension to shorten those file
081145cf 1136names, @pxref{Emacs Prettify}.)
eeaf4427
LC
1137
1138Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
1139@dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
821b0015
LC
1140use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
1141@code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
eeaf4427 1142
821b0015 1143For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
eeaf4427 1144@file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
834129e0 1145@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
821b0015
LC
1146@code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
1147simply continues to point to
834129e0 1148@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
821b0015 1149coexist on the same system without any interference.
eeaf4427 1150
e49951eb
MW
1151The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
1152packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on those per-user
821b0015 1153profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
eeaf4427
LC
1154
1155The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
1156operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
ba55b1cb 1157the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
e49951eb 1158@command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
eeaf4427
LC
1159or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
1160profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
1161
1162In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
1163for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
1164out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
4af2447e
LC
1165of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
1166system configuration is subject to transactional upgrades and roll-back
1167(@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
eeaf4427
LC
1168
1169All those packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
1170Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by the user
fe8ff028 1171profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
e49951eb 1172(@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
fe8ff028
LC
1173generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
1174collected.
eeaf4427 1175
e900c503
LC
1176@cindex reproducibility
1177@cindex reproducible builds
eeaf4427
LC
1178Finally, Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
1179management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
834129e0 1180Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
eeaf4427
LC
1181inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
1182scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
1183given package installation matches the current state of their
e900c503
LC
1184distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
1185thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
1186is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
1187machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
eeaf4427 1188
c4202d60 1189@cindex substitutes
eeaf4427 1190This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
c4202d60 1191deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
18f2887b 1192available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
c4202d60
LC
1193downloads it and unpacks it;
1194otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
1195(@pxref{Substitutes}).
eeaf4427 1196
f5fd4fd2
LC
1197Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
1198developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
1199a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
1200package, without having to manually install the package's dependencies
1201in their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1202
e49951eb
MW
1203@node Invoking guix package
1204@section Invoking @command{guix package}
eeaf4427 1205
e49951eb 1206The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
eeaf4427
LC
1207install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
1208previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
1209and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
1210is:
1211
1212@example
e49951eb 1213guix package @var{options}
eeaf4427
LC
1214@end example
1215
ba55b1cb 1216Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
eeaf4427 1217the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
99bd74d5 1218previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
eeaf4427
LC
1219want to roll back.
1220
6447738c
MW
1221For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
1222@code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
1223
1224@example
1225guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
1226@end example
1227
99bd74d5
LC
1228@command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
1229whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
1230passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
1231(@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
1232
b9e5c0a9 1233For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
0ec1af59 1234created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
b9e5c0a9
LC
1235current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
1236@file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
1237variable, and so on.
d664f1b4
LC
1238@cindex search paths
1239If you are not using the Guix System Distribution, consider adding the
1240following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
1241Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
1242shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
1243
1244@example
1245GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" \
1246source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
1247@end example
b9e5c0a9 1248
4379c35b
LC
1249In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
1250a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
1251to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
0ec1af59
LC
1252@code{@var{localstatedir}/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
1253@var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
4379c35b
LC
1254@code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
1255@file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
1256started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
1257package}.
0ec1af59
LC
1258
1259The @var{options} can be among the following:
1260
eeaf4427
LC
1261@table @code
1262
6447738c
MW
1263@item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
1264@itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
1265Install the specified @var{package}s.
eeaf4427 1266
6447738c 1267Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
eeaf4427 1268@code{guile}, or a package name followed by a hyphen and version number,
724311a2
LC
1269such as @code{guile-1.8.8} or simply @code{guile-1.8} (in the latter
1270case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
1271
1272If no version number is specified, the
dc5669cd
MW
1273newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
1274may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
6e721c4d 1275package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils-2.22:lib}
e7f34eb0
LC
1276(@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
1277name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
1278distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
eeaf4427 1279
461572cc
LC
1280@cindex propagated inputs
1281Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
21461f27
LC
1282that automatically get installed along with the required package
1283(@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
1284@code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
1285package definitions).
461572cc 1286
21461f27 1287@anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
461572cc
LC
1288An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
1289the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
1290Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
1291in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
1292also been explicitly installed independently.
1293
ba7ea5ce 1294Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
5924080d 1295variables for their search paths (see explanation of
ba7ea5ce 1296@code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
5924080d
LC
1297environment variable definitions are reported here.
1298
ef010c0f 1299@c XXX: keep me up-to-date
5924080d 1300Finally, when installing a GNU package, the tool reports the
ef010c0f
LC
1301availability of a newer upstream version. In the future, it may provide
1302the option of installing directly from the upstream version, even if
1303that version is not yet in the distribution.
1304
5d4b411f
LC
1305@item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
1306@itemx -e @var{exp}
1307Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
1308
1309@var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
1310@code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
1311between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
1312@code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
1313
1314Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
1315package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
1316multiple-output package.
1317
0d279400
DT
1318@item --install-from-file=@var{file}
1319@itemx -f @var{file}
1320Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
1321
1322As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
1323(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
1324
1325@example
1326@verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
1327@end example
1328
1329Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{package.scm} file
1330in the root of their project's source tree that can be used to test
1331development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
1332(@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1333
6447738c
MW
1334@item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
1335@itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
1336Remove the specified @var{package}s.
eeaf4427 1337
6447738c 1338As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
13ed095c
LC
1339and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
1340@code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
1341@code{glibc}.
1342
6447738c
MW
1343@item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1344@itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1345Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
1346specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
d5f01e48 1347@var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
eeaf4427 1348
f651b477
LC
1349Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
1350in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
1351you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
1352pull}).
1353
d5f01e48
MW
1354@item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1355When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
1356upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
1357upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
1358substring ``emacs'':
1359
1360@example
1361$ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
1362@end example
1363
99bd74d5 1364@item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
1b676447 1365@itemx -m @var{file}
99bd74d5
LC
1366@cindex profile declaration
1367@cindex profile manifest
1368Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
1b676447
DT
1369returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
1370
99bd74d5
LC
1371This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
1372constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
1373commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
1374control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
1375so on.
1376
1377@c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
1378@var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
1379of packages:
1b676447 1380
99bd74d5 1381@findex packages->manifest
1b676447 1382@example
99bd74d5 1383(use-package-modules guile emacs)
1b676447
DT
1384
1385(packages->manifest
99bd74d5
LC
1386 (list emacs
1387 guile-2.0
1b676447 1388 ;; Use a specific package output.
99bd74d5 1389 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
1b676447
DT
1390@end example
1391
24e262f0
LC
1392@item --roll-back
1393Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
1394the last transaction.
1395
1396When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
1397before any other actions.
1398
d9307267 1399When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
4b2bc804
NK
1400installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
1401generation}, which contains no files apart from its own meta-data.
d9307267 1402
82fe08ed
LC
1403Installing, removing, or upgrading packages from a generation that has
1404been rolled back to overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the
1405history of a profile's generations is always linear.
1406
b3bb82f1
AK
1407@item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
1408@itemx -S @var{pattern}
1409Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
1410
1411@var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
1412with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
1413specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
1414the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
1415@code{--switch-generation=+1}.
1416
1417The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
1418@code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
1419not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
1420exist, the current generation will not be changed.
1421
dbc31ab2 1422@item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
5924080d
LC
1423@cindex search paths
1424Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
1425needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
1426variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
1427of the installed packages.
1428
1429For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
1430environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
1431libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
1432Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
1433library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
1434suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
1435@code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
1436
dbc31ab2
LC
1437The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
1438shell:
1439
1440@example
1441$ eval `guix package --search-paths`
1442@end example
1443
1444@var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
1445meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
1446be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
1447variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
1448
fc2d2339
LC
1449This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
1450of several profiles. Consider this example:
1451
1452@example
1453$ guix package -p foo -i guile
1454$ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
1455$ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
1456@end example
1457
1458The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
1459variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
1460@file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
1461
1462
eeaf4427
LC
1463@item --profile=@var{profile}
1464@itemx -p @var{profile}
1465Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
1466
70915c1a
LC
1467@item --verbose
1468Produce verbose output. In particular, emit the environment's build log
1469on the standard error port.
1470
eeaf4427
LC
1471@item --bootstrap
1472Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
1473useful to distribution developers.
1474
1475@end table
1476
e49951eb 1477In addition to these actions @command{guix package} supports the
733b4130
LC
1478following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
1479availability of packages:
eeaf4427 1480
733b4130
LC
1481@table @option
1482
acc08466
NK
1483@item --search=@var{regexp}
1484@itemx -s @var{regexp}
b110869d 1485@cindex searching for packages
5763ad92 1486List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
299112d3
LC
1487@var{regexp}. Print all the meta-data of matching packages in
1488@code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
1489GNU recutils manual}).
acc08466 1490
299112d3
LC
1491This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
1492command, for instance:
1493
1494@example
e49951eb 1495$ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version
299112d3
LC
1496name: glibc
1497version: 2.17
1498
1499name: libgc
1500version: 7.2alpha6
1501@end example
acc08466 1502
a12d92f5
LC
1503Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
1504terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
1505
1506@example
1507$ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
1508name: elfutils
1509
1510name: gmp
1511@dots{}
1512@end example
1513
db5a9444
LC
1514It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s}
1515flags. For example, the following command returns a list of board
1516games:
1517
1518@example
1519$ guix package -s '\<board\>' -s game | recsel -p name
1520name: gnubg
1521@dots{}
1522@end example
1523
1524If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
1525that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
1526around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
1527keyboards.
1528
b110869d
LC
1529And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
1530for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
1531libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
1532
1533@example
1534$ guix package -s crypto -s library | \
1535 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
1536@end example
1537
1538@noindent
1539@xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
1540information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
1541
2aa6efb0
CR
1542@item --show=@var{package}
1543Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
1544@code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
1545recutils manual}).
1546
1547@example
1548$ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
1549name: python
1550version: 2.7.6
1551
1552name: python
1553version: 3.3.5
1554@end example
1555
1556You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
1557specific version of it:
1558@example
1559$ guix package --show=python-3.3.5 | recsel -p name,version
1560name: python
1561version: 3.3.5
1562@end example
1563
1564
1565
733b4130
LC
1566@item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
1567@itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
bd9bde1c
LC
1568List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
1569most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
1570specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
733b4130
LC
1571
1572For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1573tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
1574is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
1575@code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
1576the store.
1577
64fc89b6
LC
1578@item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
1579@itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
5763ad92 1580List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
a1ba8475
LC
1581(@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
1582installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
64fc89b6
LC
1583
1584For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
6e721c4d
LC
1585its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
1586Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
64fc89b6 1587
f566d765
LC
1588@item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1589@itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
1590Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
1591generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
4b2bc804
NK
1592installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
1593shown.
f566d765
LC
1594
1595For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1596tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
1597that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
1598location of this package in the store.
1599
1600When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
1601generations. Valid patterns include:
1602
1603@itemize
1604@item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
1605generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
1606the first one.
1607
1608And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
1609specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
1610
1611@item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
1612specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
1613a range must be lesser than its end.
1614
1615It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
1616@code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
1617second one.
1618
1619@item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
1620or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
d7ddb257
LC
1621duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
1622that are up to 20 days old.
f566d765
LC
1623@end itemize
1624
b7884ca3
NK
1625@item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1626@itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
d7ddb257
LC
1627When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
1628one.
b7884ca3
NK
1629
1630This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
d7ddb257
LC
1631When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
1632@var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
1633specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
1634deletes generations that are more than one month old.
1635
391bdd8f
LC
1636If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
1637zeroth generation is never deleted.
b7884ca3 1638
1bb9900a
LC
1639Note that deleting generations prevents roll-back to them.
1640Consequently, this command must be used with care.
1641
733b4130 1642@end table
eeaf4427 1643
70ee5642 1644Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
ccd7158d 1645processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
b8638f03
LC
1646Options}). It also support package transformation options, such as
1647@option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
1648However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
1649preserve transformation across upgrades, you should define your own
1650package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
1651(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
1652
70ee5642 1653
c4202d60
LC
1654@node Substitutes
1655@section Substitutes
1656
1657@cindex substitutes
1658@cindex pre-built binaries
1659Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
1660can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
1661server. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they are
1662substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
1663substitute is much faster than building things locally.
1664
1665Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
1666(@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
1667pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
1668also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
1669
1670The @code{hydra.gnu.org} server is a front-end to a build farm that
1671builds packages from the GNU distribution continuously for some
32950fc8
AK
1672architectures, and makes them available as substitutes (@pxref{Emacs
1673Hydra}, for information on how to query the continuous integration
1674server). This is the
f8a8e0fe
LC
1675default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
1676@option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
1677(@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
1678or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
1679(@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
1680option}).
c4202d60
LC
1681
1682@cindex security
1683@cindex digital signatures
1684To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org}, you
1685must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
1686imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
1687archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{hydra.gnu.org} to not
1688be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
1689
1690This public key is installed along with Guix, in
1691@code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
1692the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
1693make sure you checked the GPG signature of
1694@file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
1695Then, you can run something like this:
1696
1697@example
1698# guix archive --authorize < hydra.gnu.org.pub
1699@end example
1700
1701Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
1702should change from something like:
1703
1704@example
1705$ guix build emacs --dry-run
1706The following derivations would be built:
1707 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
1708 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
1709 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
1710 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
1711@dots{}
1712@end example
1713
1714@noindent
1715to something like:
1716
1717@example
1718$ guix build emacs --dry-run
1719The following files would be downloaded:
1720 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
1721 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
1722 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
1723 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
1724@dots{}
1725@end example
1726
1727@noindent
1728This indicates that substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} are usable and
1729will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
1730
1731Guix ignores substitutes that are not signed, or that are not signed by
ef27aa9c 1732one of the keys listed in the ACL. It also detects and raises an error
c4202d60
LC
1733when attempting to use a substitute that has been tampered with.
1734
e0c941fe
LC
1735@vindex http_proxy
1736Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP. The @code{http_proxy} environment
1737variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
1738honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
1739@code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
1740@command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
1741@emph{absolutely no effect}.
1742
c4202d60
LC
1743The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
1744@code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
1745guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
1746@code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
1747build}, and other command-line tools.
1748
1749
1750Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
1751mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
1752determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
1753weaknesses. While using @code{hydra.gnu.org} substitutes can be
1754convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
1755their own build farm, such that @code{hydra.gnu.org} is less of an
8ce229fc
LC
1756interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
1757build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
1758of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
c4202d60
LC
1759
1760Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
1761(@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
1762package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
1763a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
d23c20f1
LC
1764integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
1765help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
1766finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
a8d65643
LC
1767challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
1768build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
1769are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
1770@command{guix build --check}}).
c4202d60
LC
1771
1772In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
1773binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
1774like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
1775
1776
6e721c4d
LC
1777@node Packages with Multiple Outputs
1778@section Packages with Multiple Outputs
1779
1780@cindex multiple-output packages
1781@cindex package outputs
1782
1783Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
1784source package leads exactly one directory in the store. When running
1785@command{guix package -i glibc}, one installs the default output of the
1786GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
1787can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
1788default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
1789libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
1790files.
1791
1792Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
1793produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
1794instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
1795installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
1796To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
1797separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
1798which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
1799
1800@example
1801guix package -i glib
1802@end example
1803
1804The command to install its documentation is:
1805
1806@example
1807guix package -i glib:doc
1808@end example
1809
1810Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
1811For instance, the WordNet package install both command-line tools and
1812graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
1813library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
1814libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
1815output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
fcc58db6
LC
1816who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
1817can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
88856916 1818@command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
6e721c4d
LC
1819
1820There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
91ef73d4
LC
1821Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
1822possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
1823@code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
1824Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
1825the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
1826guix package}).
6e721c4d 1827
eeaf4427 1828
e49951eb
MW
1829@node Invoking guix gc
1830@section Invoking @command{guix gc}
fe8ff028
LC
1831
1832@cindex garbage collector
1833Packages that are installed but not used may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
e49951eb 1834The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
c22eb992
LC
1835collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
1836the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
1837files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
fe8ff028
LC
1838
1839The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
834129e0 1840@file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
fe8ff028
LC
1841cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
1842deleted. The set of garbage collector roots includes default user
e49951eb
MW
1843profiles, and may be augmented with @command{guix build --root}, for
1844example (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
fe8ff028 1845
1bb9900a
LC
1846Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
1847often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
1848package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
1849is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
1850(@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
1851
e49951eb 1852The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
fe8ff028 1853used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
7770aafc
LC
1854files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
1855information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
1856options are as follows:
fe8ff028
LC
1857
1858@table @code
1859@item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
1860@itemx -C [@var{min}]
834129e0 1861Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
fe8ff028
LC
1862sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
1863specified.
1864
1865When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
1866@var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4a44d7bb
LC
1867suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
1868(@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
fe8ff028
LC
1869
1870When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
1871
1872@item --delete
1873@itemx -d
1874Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
1875arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
1876they are still live.
1877
30d9aa54
LC
1878@item --list-failures
1879List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
1880
1881This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
1882@option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
1883@option{--cache-failures}}).
1884
1885@item --clear-failures
1886Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
1887
1888Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
1889@option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
1890
fe8ff028
LC
1891@item --list-dead
1892Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
1893store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
1894
1895@item --list-live
1896Show the list of live store files and directories.
ba8b732d
LC
1897
1898@end table
1899
1900In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
1901
1902@table @code
1903
1904@item --references
1905@itemx --referrers
1906List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
1907as arguments.
1908
8e59fdd5
LC
1909@item --requisites
1910@itemx -R
fcc58db6 1911@cindex closure
8e59fdd5
LC
1912List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
1913include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
1914of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
1915@dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
1916
fcc58db6 1917@xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of an
88856916
LC
1918element's closure. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
1919the graph of references.
fcc58db6 1920
fe8ff028
LC
1921@end table
1922
7770aafc
LC
1923Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
1924store and to control disk usage.
1925
1926@table @option
1927
1928@item --verify[=@var{options}]
1929@cindex integrity, of the store
1930@cindex integrity checking
1931Verify the integrity of the store.
1932
1933By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
1934daemon's database actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
1935
1936When provided, @var{options} must a comma-separated list containing one
1937or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
1938
1939When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon will compute the
1940content hash of each store item and compare it against its hash in the
1941database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
1942traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
1943long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
1944
1945@cindex repairing the store
1946Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
1947causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
1948substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
1949atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
1950system administrator.
1951
1952@item --optimize
1953@cindex deduplication
1954Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
1955@dfn{deduplication}.
1956
1957The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
1958import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
1959(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
1960this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
1961@code{--disable-deduplication}.
1962
1963@end table
eeaf4427 1964
f651b477
LC
1965@node Invoking guix pull
1966@section Invoking @command{guix pull}
1967
1968Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
1969the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
1970that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
1971pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
1972descriptions, and deploys it.
1973
1974On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
1975versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
1976the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
1977version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
ef54b61d
AV
1978become available@footnote{Under the hood, @command{guix pull} updates
1979the @file{~/.config/guix/latest} symbolic link to point to the latest
1980Guix, and the @command{guix} command loads code from there.}.
f651b477
LC
1981
1982The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
1983but it supports the following options:
1984
1985@table @code
1986@item --verbose
1987Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
1988
ab5d72ad
LC
1989@item --url=@var{url}
1990Download the source tarball of Guix from @var{url}.
1991
1992By default, the tarball is taken from its canonical address at
1993@code{gnu.org}, for the stable branch of Guix.
1994
f651b477
LC
1995@item --bootstrap
1996Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
1997useful to Guix developers.
1998@end table
1999
760c60d6
LC
2000
2001@node Invoking guix archive
2002@section Invoking @command{guix archive}
2003
2004The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
2005from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them.
2006In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
2007to another machine's store. For example, to transfer the @code{emacs}
2008package to a machine connected over SSH, one would run:
2009
2010@example
56607088 2011guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
760c60d6
LC
2012@end example
2013
87236aed 2014@noindent
56607088
LC
2015Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
2016to another like this:
2017
2018@example
2019guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
2020 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
2021@end example
2022
2023@noindent
2024However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
2025profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
2026@code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the target
2027machine's store. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
2028items are missing from the target's store.
87236aed 2029
760c60d6 2030Archives are stored in the ``Nix archive'' or ``Nar'' format, which is
0dbd88db
LC
2031comparable in spirit to `tar', but with a few noteworthy differences
2032that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
2033recording all Unix meta-data for each file, the Nar format only mentions
2034the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
2035and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
2036entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
2037the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
2038deterministic.
2039
2040When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
2041and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
2042verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
2043signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
760c60d6
LC
2044@c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
2045
2046The main options are:
2047
2048@table @code
2049@item --export
2050Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
2051resulting archive to the standard output.
2052
56607088
LC
2053Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
2054@code{--recursive} is passed.
2055
2056@item -r
2057@itemx --recursive
2058When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
2059archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
2060Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
2061of the exported store items.
2062
760c60d6
LC
2063@item --import
2064Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
2065therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
f82cc5fd
LC
2066signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
2067keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
554f26ec 2068
87236aed
LC
2069@item --missing
2070Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
2071and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
2072the store.
2073
554f26ec 2074@item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
f82cc5fd 2075@cindex signing, archives
554f26ec
LC
2076Generate a new key pair for the daemons. This is a prerequisite before
2077archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
2078usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
2079generate the key pair.
2080
2081The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
2082@file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
867d8473
LC
2083key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
2084an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
2085versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
2086Alternately, @var{parameters} can specify
554f26ec
LC
2087@code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
2088public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
2089Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
f82cc5fd
LC
2090
2091@item --authorize
2092@cindex authorizing, archives
2093Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
2094The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
2095same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
2096
2097The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
2098@file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
2099@url{http://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
2100s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
2101@url{http://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
2102(SPKI)}.
c6f8e9dd
LC
2103
2104@item --extract=@var{directory}
2105@itemx -x @var{directory}
2106Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
2107(@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
2108low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
2109
2110For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
2111served by @code{hydra.gnu.org} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
2112
2113@example
2114$ wget -O - \
2115 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
2116 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
2117@end example
2118
2119Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
2120by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
2121and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
2122@emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
2123unsafe.
2124
2125The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
2126archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
2127
760c60d6
LC
2128@end table
2129
2130To export store files as an archive to the standard output, run:
2131
2132@example
2133guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
2134@end example
2135
2136@var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
2137specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2138package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
2139containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
2140output of @code{emacs}:
2141
2142@example
834129e0 2143guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
760c60d6
LC
2144@end example
2145
2146If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
2147automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
ccd7158d 2148common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
760c60d6 2149
c554de89
AK
2150@c *********************************************************************
2151@include emacs.texi
760c60d6 2152
568717fd
LC
2153@c *********************************************************************
2154@node Programming Interface
2155@chapter Programming Interface
2156
3dc1970d
LC
2157GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
2158define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
2159write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
2160familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
2161its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
2162turned into concrete build actions.
2163
ba55b1cb 2164Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
3dc1970d 2165standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
834129e0 2166@file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
3dc1970d
LC
2167setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
2168build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
2169
2170@cindex derivation
2171Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
2172store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
2173provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
2174representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
2175which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
49ad317a
LC
2176assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
2177that build results @emph{derive} from them.
3dc1970d
LC
2178
2179This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
2180package definitions.
2181
568717fd 2182@menu
b860f382 2183* Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
7458bd0a 2184* Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
b860f382
LC
2185* The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
2186* Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
2187* The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
21b679f6 2188* G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
568717fd
LC
2189@end menu
2190
2191@node Defining Packages
2192@section Defining Packages
2193
3dc1970d
LC
2194The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
2195@code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
2196example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
2197package looks like this:
2198
2199@example
e7f34eb0
LC
2200(define-module (gnu packages hello)
2201 #:use-module (guix packages)
2202 #:use-module (guix download)
2203 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
a6dcdcac
SB
2204 #:use-module (guix licenses)
2205 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
b22a12fd 2206
79f5dd59 2207(define-public hello
3dc1970d
LC
2208 (package
2209 (name "hello")
17d8e33f 2210 (version "2.10")
3dc1970d 2211 (source (origin
17d8e33f
ML
2212 (method url-fetch)
2213 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
2214 ".tar.gz"))
2215 (sha256
2216 (base32
2217 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
3dc1970d 2218 (build-system gnu-build-system)
7458bd0a 2219 (arguments `(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
3dc1970d 2220 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
7458bd0a
LC
2221 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
2222 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
3dc1970d 2223 (home-page "http://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
b22a12fd 2224 (license gpl3+)))
3dc1970d
LC
2225@end example
2226
2227@noindent
2228Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
e7f34eb0 2229of the various fields here. This expression binds variable @code{hello}
3dc1970d
LC
2230to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
2231(@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
2232This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
2233@code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
2234returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
2235
2f7d2d91
LC
2236With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
2237the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
2238@code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
2239
e7f34eb0
LC
2240In the example above, @var{hello} is defined into a module of its own,
2241@code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
2242necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
2243modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
2244the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2245
3dc1970d
LC
2246There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
2247
2248@itemize
2249@item
a2bf4907
LC
2250The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
2251(@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
3dc1970d
LC
2252Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
2253meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
2254
2255The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
2256the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
2257
2258The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
2259being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
2260integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6c365eca 2261base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
210cc920
LC
2262@code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
2263hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
3dc1970d 2264
f9cc8971
LC
2265@cindex patches
2266When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
2267listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
2268Scheme expression to modify the source code.
2269
3dc1970d
LC
2270@item
2271@cindex GNU Build System
7458bd0a
LC
2272The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
2273package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
2274represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
2275configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
2276make && make check && make install} command sequence.
2277
2278@item
2279The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
2280(@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
2281@var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
2282@code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
3dc1970d
LC
2283
2284@item
2285The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
2286build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
2287input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
2288variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
2289
2290Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
2291be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
7458bd0a 2292of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
3dc1970d
LC
2293
2294However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
2295@code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
2296unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
2297@end itemize
2298
87eafdbd
TUBK
2299@xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
2300
2f7d2d91 2301Once a package definition is in place, the
e49951eb 2302package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
39bee8a2
LC
2303tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). You can easily jump back to the
2304package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
2305(@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
2306@xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
b4f5e0e8
CR
2307more information on how to test package definitions, and
2308@ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
2309for style conformance.
2310
7458bd0a
LC
2311Eventually, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
2312can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
2313(@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
3dc1970d
LC
2314
2315Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
2316object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
834129e0 2317That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
ba55b1cb 2318The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
3dc1970d
LC
2319@code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
2320
2321@deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
59688fc4
LC
2322Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
2323(@pxref{Derivations}).
3dc1970d
LC
2324
2325@var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
2326must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
2327@code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
2328must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
2329(@pxref{The Store}).
2330@end deffn
568717fd 2331
9c1edabd
LC
2332@noindent
2333@cindex cross-compilation
2334Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
2335package for some other system:
2336
2337@deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
2338 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
59688fc4
LC
2339Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
2340@var{system} to @var{target}.
9c1edabd
LC
2341
2342@var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
2343and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
2344(@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU configuration triplets,, configure, GNU
2345Configure and Build System}).
2346@end deffn
2347
87eafdbd
TUBK
2348@menu
2349* package Reference :: The package data type.
2350* origin Reference:: The origin data type.
2351@end menu
2352
2353
2354@node package Reference
2355@subsection @code{package} Reference
2356
2357This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
2358declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2359
2360@deftp {Data Type} package
2361This is the data type representing a package recipe.
2362
2363@table @asis
2364@item @code{name}
2365The name of the package, as a string.
2366
2367@item @code{version}
2368The version of the package, as a string.
2369
2370@item @code{source}
2371An origin object telling how the source code for the package should be
2372acquired (@pxref{origin Reference}).
2373
2374@item @code{build-system}
2375The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
2376Systems}).
2377
2378@item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
2379The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
2380list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
2381
2382@item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
70650c68
LC
2383@itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2384@itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2385@cindex inputs, of packages
2386These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
2387tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
2388first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
2389and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
2390defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
2391more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies 3
2392inputs:
87eafdbd 2393
70650c68
LC
2394@example
2395`(("libffi" ,libffi)
2396 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
2397 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
2398@end example
2399
2400@cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
2401The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
2402necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
2403dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
2404architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
2405are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
2406
2407@code{native-inputs} is typically where you would list tools needed at
2408build time but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
2409Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
2410this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
2411
2412@anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
2413Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
2414specified packages will be force-installed alongside the package they
2415belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
2416package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
2417propagated inputs.)
21461f27 2418
e0508b6b
LC
2419For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
2420another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
2421one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
2422
2423Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for
2424languages that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin
2425to ELF's @code{RUNPATH}; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, GHC, and
2426more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
2427library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
2428listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
87eafdbd 2429
87eafdbd
TUBK
2430@item @code{self-native-input?} (default: @code{#f})
2431This is a Boolean field telling whether the package should use itself as
2432a native input when cross-compiling.
2433
2434@item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
2435The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
2436Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
2437
2438@item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2439@itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2440A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
2441search-path environment variables honored by the package.
2442
2443@item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
2444This must either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
2445@dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
2446for details.
2447
2448@item @code{synopsis}
2449A one-line description of the package.
2450
2451@item @code{description}
2452A more elaborate description of the package.
2453
2454@item @code{license}
2455The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)}.
2456
2457@item @code{home-page}
2458The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
2459
2460@item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
2461The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
2462@code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
2463
2464@item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
2465The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
2466
2467@item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
2468The source location of the package. It's useful to override this when
2469inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
2470automatically corrected.
2471@end table
2472@end deftp
2473
2474
2475@node origin Reference
2476@subsection @code{origin} Reference
2477
2478This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
2479declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2480
2481@deftp {Data Type} origin
2482This is the data type representing a source code origin.
2483
2484@table @asis
2485@item @code{uri}
2486An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
2487the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
2488@var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
2489values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
2490
2491@item @code{method}
2492A procedure that will handle the URI.
2493
2494Examples include:
2495
2496@table @asis
2497@item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
2498download a file the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
2499@code{uri} field;
2500
2501@item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
2502clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
2503specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
2504@code{git-reference} looks like this:
2505
2506@example
2507(git-reference
2508 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
2509 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
2510@end example
2511@end table
2512
2513@item @code{sha256}
2514A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
2515@code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
2516base-32 string.
2517
2518@item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
2519The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
2520@code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
2521the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
2522used. For version control checkouts, it's recommended to provide the
2523file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
2524
2525@item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
2526A list of file names containing patches to be applied to the source.
2527
2528@item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
2529A quoted piece of code that will be run in the source directory to make
2530any modifications, which is sometimes more convenient than a patch.
2531
2532@item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
2533A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
2534command.
2535
2536@item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
2537Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
2538@code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
2539such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
2540
2541@item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
2542A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
2543process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
2544
2545@item @code{imported-modules} (default: @code{'()})
2546The list of Guile modules to import in the patch derivation, for use by
2547the @code{snippet}.
2548
2549@item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
2550The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
2551this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
2552@end table
2553@end deftp
2554
9c1edabd 2555
7458bd0a
LC
2556@node Build Systems
2557@section Build Systems
2558
2559@cindex build system
2560Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
2561that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
2562field represents the build procedure of the package, as well implicit
2563dependencies of that build procedure.
2564
2565Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
2566create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
2567module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
2568
f5fd4fd2 2569@cindex bag (low-level package representation)
0d5a559f
LC
2570Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
2571@dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
2572ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
2573a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
2574that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
2575representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
2576
7458bd0a
LC
2577Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
2578definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
2579(@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
2580(@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
2581Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
2582evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
2583by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
2584
2585The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
2586standard build procedure for GNU packages and many other packages. It
2587is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
2588
2589@defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
2590@var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
2591thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
2592standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
2593
2594@cindex build phases
2595In a nutshell, packages using it configured, built, and installed with
2596the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
2597command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
2598All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
2599notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
2600modules for more details about the build phases.}:
2601
2602@table @code
2603@item unpack
2604Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
2605extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
2606to the build tree, and enter that directory.
2607
2608@item patch-source-shebangs
2609Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
2610store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
2611@code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
2612
2613@item configure
2614Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
2615as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
2616by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
2617
2618@item build
2619Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
0917e80e 2620@code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
7458bd0a
LC
2621(the default), build with @code{make -j}.
2622
2623@item check
2624Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
2625@code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
2626@code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
2627check -j}.
2628
2629@item install
2630Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
2631
2632@item patch-shebangs
2633Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
2634
2635@item strip
2636Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
2637is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
2638(@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
2639@end table
2640
2641@vindex %standard-phases
2642The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
2643@var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
2644@var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
2645procedure implements the actual phase.
2646
2647The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
2648@code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
2649
2650@example
2651#:phases (alist-delete 'configure %standard-phases)
2652@end example
2653
9bf404e9 2654means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
7458bd0a
LC
2655@code{configure} phase.
2656
2657In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
2658for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
2659Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
2660build-system gnu)} module for a complete list.) We call these the
2661@dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions don't
2662have to mention them.
2663@end defvr
2664
2665Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
2666conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
2667of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
2668implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
2669executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
2670
2671@defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
2672This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
2673implements the build procedure for packages using the
2674@url{http://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
2675
2676It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
2677Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
2678parameter.
9849cfc1
LC
2679
2680The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
2681passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
2682parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
2683it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
2684debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
2685@code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7458bd0a
LC
2686@end defvr
2687
3afcf52b
FB
2688@defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
2689This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
2690is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
2691
2692This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
2693@var{gnu-build-system}:
2694
2695@table @code
2696@item glib-or-gtk-wrap
2697The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs found under
2698@file{bin/} are able to find GLib's ``schemas'' and
2699@uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
2700modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
2701that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
2702environment variables.
2703
73aa8ddb
LC
2704It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
2705process by listing their names in the
2706@code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
2707when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
2708where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
2709GLib and GTK+.
2710
3afcf52b
FB
2711@item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
2712The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all GLib's
2713@uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
2714GSettings schemas} are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
2715@command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
2716@code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
2717The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
2718specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
2719@end table
2720
2721Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
2722@end defvr
2723
7458bd0a
LC
2724@defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
2725This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
2726implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
2727packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
2728then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
2729
2730For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
2731it takes care of wrapping these programs so their @code{PYTHONPATH}
2732environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
2733
2734Which Python package is used can be specified with the @code{#:python}
2735parameter.
2736@end defvr
2737
2738@defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
2739This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
2d2a53fc
EB
2740implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
2741consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
2742followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
2743@code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
2744@code{make} and @code{make install}; depending on which of
2745@code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
2746distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
2747and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
2748preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
2749@code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
2750
2751The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
2752passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
2753@code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
7458bd0a
LC
2754
2755Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
2756@end defvr
2757
f8f3bef6
RW
2758@defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
2759This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
2760implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://r-project.org, R}
2761packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
2762INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
2763@code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
2764are run after installation using the R function
2765@code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
2766@end defvr
2767
c08f9818
DT
2768@defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
2769This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
2770implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
2771involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
2772
5dc87623
DT
2773The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
2774typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
2775developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
2776the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
2777repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
2778tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
2779a traditional source release tarball.
e83c6d00 2780
c08f9818 2781Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6e9f2913
PP
2782parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
2783command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
c08f9818 2784@end defvr
7458bd0a 2785
a677c726
RW
2786@defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
2787This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
2788implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
2789phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
2790implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
2791script.
2792
2793The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
2794Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
2795@code{#:python} parameter.
2796@end defvr
2797
14dfdf2e
FB
2798@defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
2799This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
2800implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
2801involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
2802--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
2803Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
2804install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
2805compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
2806Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
2807addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
2808running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
2809is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
2810the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
2811not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
2812
2813Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
a54bd6d7 2814parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
14dfdf2e
FB
2815@end defvr
2816
e9137a53
FB
2817@defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
2818This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
2819implements an installation procedure similar to the one of Emacs' own
2820packaging system (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
2821
2822It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
2823byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
2824packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
2825documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
2826package is installed in its own directory under
2827@file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
2828@end defvr
2829
7458bd0a
LC
2830Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
2831``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
2832it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
2833and does not have a notion of build phases.
2834
2835@defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
2836This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
2837
2838This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
2839must be a Scheme expression that builds the package's output(s)---as
2840with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
2841@code{build-expression->derivation}}).
2842@end defvr
2843
568717fd
LC
2844@node The Store
2845@section The Store
2846
e531ac2a
LC
2847@cindex store
2848@cindex store paths
2849
2850Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is where derivations that have been
834129e0 2851successfully built are stored---by default, under @file{/gnu/store}.
e531ac2a 2852Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store paths}. The
4988dd40 2853store has an associated database that contains information such as the
e531ac2a
LC
2854store paths referred to by each store path, and the list of @emph{valid}
2855store paths---paths that result from a successful build.
2856
2857The store is always accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
2858(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
2859connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send it requests, and
2860read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
2861
2862The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
2863daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below.
2864
2865@deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{file}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
2866Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{file}. When
2867@var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
2868extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
2869operate, should the disk become full. Return a server object.
2870
2871@var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
2872location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
2873@end deffn
2874
2875@deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
2876Close the connection to @var{server}.
2877@end deffn
2878
2879@defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
2880This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
2881where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
2882@end defvr
2883
2884Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
2885argument.
2886
2887@deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
2888Return @code{#t} when @var{path} is a valid store path.
2889@end deffn
2890
cfbf9160 2891@deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
e531ac2a
LC
2892Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
2893path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
2894resulting store path.
2895@end deffn
2896
874e6874 2897@deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
59688fc4
LC
2898Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
2899derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
2900Return @code{#t} on success.
874e6874
LC
2901@end deffn
2902
b860f382
LC
2903Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
2904monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
2905more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
2906Store Monad}).
2907
e531ac2a
LC
2908@c FIXME
2909@i{This section is currently incomplete.}
568717fd
LC
2910
2911@node Derivations
2912@section Derivations
2913
874e6874
LC
2914@cindex derivations
2915Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
2916are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contain the
2917following pieces of information:
2918
2919@itemize
2920@item
2921The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
2922directory in the store, but may produce more.
2923
2924@item
2925The inputs of the derivations, which may be other derivations or plain
2926files in the store (patches, build scripts, etc.)
2927
2928@item
2929The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
2930
2931@item
2932The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
2933to be passed.
2934
2935@item
2936A list of environment variables to be defined.
2937
2938@end itemize
2939
2940@cindex derivation path
2941Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
2942the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
2943both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
2944name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
2945paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
2946procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
2947Store}).
2948
2949The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
2950derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
2951otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
2952a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
2953
1909431c
LC
2954@deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
2955 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
2096ef47 2956 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
1909431c 2957 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
4a6aeb67
LC
2958 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
2959 [#:substitutable? #t]
59688fc4
LC
2960Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
2961@code{<derivation>} object.
874e6874 2962
2096ef47 2963When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
874e6874 2964@dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
36bbbbd1
LC
2965known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
2966@var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
2967file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
2968containing this output.
5b0c9d16 2969
858e9282 2970When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
5b0c9d16
LC
2971name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
2972path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
2973a simple text format.
1909431c 2974
b53be755
LC
2975When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
2976or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to.
2977
c0468155
LC
2978When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
2979denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
2980daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
2981to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
2982use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
2983derivations that download files.
2984
1909431c
LC
2985When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
2986good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
2987(@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
2988where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
4a6aeb67
LC
2989
2990When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
2991derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
2992useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
2993host CPU instruction set.
874e6874
LC
2994@end deffn
2995
2996@noindent
2997Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
2998@var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
2999to a Bash executable in the store:
3000
3001@lisp
3002(use-modules (guix utils)
3003 (guix store)
3004 (guix derivations))
3005
59688fc4
LC
3006(let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
3007 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
3008 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
3009 (derivation store "foo"
3010 bash `("-e" ,builder)
21b679f6 3011 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
59688fc4 3012 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
834129e0 3013@result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
874e6874
LC
3014@end lisp
3015
21b679f6
LC
3016As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
3017better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
3018best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
3019``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
6621cdb6 3020information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
21b679f6
LC
3021
3022Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
3023derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
3024@code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
3025is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
874e6874 3026
dd1a5a15
LC
3027@deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
3028 @var{name} @var{exp} @
3029 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
3030 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
36bbbbd1 3031 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
63a42824 3032 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
4a6aeb67 3033 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
874e6874
LC
3034Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
3035builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
3036@code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
3037@code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
3038modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
3039compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
3040@var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
3041gnu-build-system))}.
3042
3043@var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
3044to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
3045to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
3046Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
3047and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
3048terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
3049@var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
3050
3051@var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
3052@var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
3053@code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
9c629a27 3054
63a42824 3055See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
4a6aeb67
LC
3056@var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references}, @var{local-build?},
3057and @var{substitutable?}.
874e6874
LC
3058@end deffn
3059
3060@noindent
3061Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
3062containing one file:
3063
3064@lisp
3065(let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
834129e0 3066 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
874e6874
LC
3067 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
3068 (lambda (p)
3069 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
dd1a5a15 3070 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
874e6874 3071
834129e0 3072@result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
874e6874
LC
3073@end lisp
3074
568717fd 3075
b860f382
LC
3076@node The Store Monad
3077@section The Store Monad
3078
3079@cindex monad
3080
3081The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
3082sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
3083argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
3084side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
3085
3086The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
3087carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
3088functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
3089latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
3090and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
3091
3092@cindex monadic values
3093@cindex monadic functions
3094This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
3095provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
3096useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
3097construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
3098(in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
561fb6c3 3099computations (here computations include accesses to the store.) Values
b860f382
LC
3100in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
3101@dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
3102@dfn{monadic procedures}.
3103
3104Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
3105
3106@example
45adbd62
LC
3107(define (sh-symlink store)
3108 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
3109 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
3110 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
3111 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
3112 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
3113 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
b860f382
LC
3114@end example
3115
c6f30b81
LC
3116Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
3117as a monadic function:
b860f382
LC
3118
3119@example
45adbd62 3120(define (sh-symlink)
b860f382 3121 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
c6f30b81
LC
3122 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
3123 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3124 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
3125 #$output))))
b860f382
LC
3126@end example
3127
c6f30b81
LC
3128There several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
3129parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
3130@code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
3131procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
3132is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
3133
3134As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
3135omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
3136(@pxref{G-Expressions}):
3137
3138@example
3139(define (sh-symlink)
3140 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3141 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
3142 #$output)))
3143@end example
b860f382 3144
7ce21611
LC
3145@c See
3146@c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
3147@c for the funny quote.
3148Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
3149said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
3150So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
3151@code{run-with-store}:
b860f382
LC
3152
3153@example
8e9aa37f
CAW
3154(run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
3155@result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
b860f382
LC
3156@end example
3157
b9b86078
LC
3158Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends Guile's REPL with
3159new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
3160@code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former, is used
3161to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
3162
3163@example
3164scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
3165$1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3166@end example
3167
3168The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
3169automatically run through the store:
3170
3171@example
3172scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
3173store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
3174$2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3175store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
3176$3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
3177store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
3178scheme@@(guile-user)>
3179@end example
3180
3181@noindent
3182Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
3183@code{store-monad} REPL.
3184
e87f0591
LC
3185The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
3186the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
b860f382
LC
3187
3188@deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
3189Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
3190in @var{monad}.
3191@end deffn
3192
3193@deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
3194Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
3195@end deffn
3196
751630c9 3197@deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
b860f382 3198@dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
751630c9
LC
3199procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
3200referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
3201Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
3202Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
3203in this example:
3204
3205@example
3206(run-with-state
3207 (with-monad %state-monad
3208 (>>= (return 1)
3209 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
3210 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
3211 'some-state)
3212
3213@result{} 4
3214@result{} some-state
3215@end example
b860f382
LC
3216@end deffn
3217
3218@deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3219 @var{body} ...
3220@deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3221 @var{body} ...
3222Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
3223@var{body}. The form (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the
3224``normal'' value @var{val}, as per @code{let}.
3225
3226@code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
3227(@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3228@end deffn
3229
405a9d4e
LC
3230@deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
3231Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
3232returning the result of the last expression.
3233
3234This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
3235monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
3236@code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
3237@end deffn
3238
561fb6c3
LC
3239@cindex state monad
3240The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
3241allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
3242monadic procedure calls.
3243
3244@defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
3245The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
3246the state that is threaded.
3247
3248Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
3249in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
3250increments the current state value:
3251
3252@example
3253(define (square x)
3254 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
3255 (mbegin %state-monad
3256 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
3257 (return (* x x)))))
3258
3259(run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
3260@result{} (0 1 4)
3261@result{} 3
3262@end example
3263
3264When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
3265value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
3266@end defvr
3267
3268@deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
3269Return the current state as a monadic value.
3270@end deffn
3271
3272@deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
3273Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
3274monadic value.
3275@end deffn
3276
3277@deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
3278Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
3279and return the previous state as a monadic value.
3280@end deffn
3281
3282@deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
3283Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
3284The state is assumed to be a list.
3285@end deffn
3286
3287@deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
3288Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
3289state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
3290@end deffn
3291
e87f0591
LC
3292The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
3293store)} module, is as follows.
b860f382
LC
3294
3295@defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
561fb6c3
LC
3296The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
3297
3298Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
3299effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
3300passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
b860f382
LC
3301@end defvr
3302
3303@deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
3304Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
3305open store connection.
3306@end deffn
3307
ad372953 3308@deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
b860f382 3309Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
ad372953
LC
3310containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
3311resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
45adbd62
LC
3312@end deffn
3313
0a90af15
LC
3314@deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3315 [#:recursive? #t]
3316Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
3317@var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
3318@var{name} is omitted.
3319
3320When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
3321recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
3322is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
3323
3324The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
3325
3326@example
3327(run-with-store (open-connection)
3328 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
3329 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
3330 (return (list a b))))
3331
3332@result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
3333@end example
3334
3335@end deffn
3336
e87f0591
LC
3337The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
3338monadic procedures:
3339
b860f382 3340@deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
4231f05b
LC
3341 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
3342 [#:output "out"] Return as a monadic
b860f382
LC
3343value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
3344directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
4231f05b
LC
3345of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
3346true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
b860f382
LC
3347@end deffn
3348
b860f382 3349@deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
4231f05b
LC
3350@deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
3351 @var{target} [@var{system}]
3352Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
3353@code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
b860f382
LC
3354@end deffn
3355
3356
21b679f6
LC
3357@node G-Expressions
3358@section G-Expressions
3359
3360@cindex G-expression
3361@cindex build code quoting
3362So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
3363to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
3364Those build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
3365build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
3366(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
3367
3368@cindex strata of code
3369It should come as no surprise that we like to write those build actions
3370in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
3371code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
ef4ab0a4
LC
3372Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
3373Kiselyov, who has written insightful
3374@url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
3375on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
3376@dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
3377to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
3378performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
3379@command{make}, etc.
21b679f6
LC
3380
3381To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
3382embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
3383code as data, and Scheme's homoiconicity---code has a direct
3384representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
3385Scheme's normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism to construct build
3386expressions.
3387
3388The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
3389S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
3390@dfn{gexps}, consist essentially in three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
3391@code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
3392@code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable respectively to
3393@code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing}
3394(@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile, GNU Guile
3395Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
3396
3397@itemize
3398@item
3399Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
3400processes.
3401
3402@item
b39fc6f7
LC
3403When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
3404inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
3405introduced.
ff40e9b7 3406
21b679f6
LC
3407@item
3408Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
3409and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
3410processes that use them.
3411@end itemize
3412
c2b84676 3413@cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
343eacbe
LC
3414This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
3415objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
c2b84676
LC
3416derivations or files in the store can be defined,
3417such that these objects can also be inserted
343eacbe
LC
3418into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level object that can be
3419inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
3420add files to the store and refer to them in
558e8b11
LC
3421derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
3422below.)
b39fc6f7 3423
21b679f6
LC
3424To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
3425
3426@example
3427(define build-exp
3428 #~(begin
3429 (mkdir #$output)
3430 (chdir #$output)
aff8ce7c 3431 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
21b679f6
LC
3432 "list-files")))
3433@end example
3434
3435This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
3436derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
3437@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
3438
3439@example
3440(gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
3441@end example
3442
e20fd1bf 3443As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
21b679f6
LC
3444substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
3445actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
3446the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
3447output)}) is replaced by a string containing the derivation's output
667b2508
LC
3448directory name.
3449
3450@cindex cross compilation
3451In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
3452references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
3453host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
3454@code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
3455native package build:
3456
3457@example
3458(gexp->derivation "vi"
3459 #~(begin
3460 (mkdir #$output)
3461 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
3462 "-s"
3463 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
3464 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
3465 #:target "mips64el-linux")
3466@end example
3467
3468@noindent
3469In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
3470that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
3471cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
3472
3473The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
21b679f6
LC
3474
3475@deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
3476@deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
3477Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
3478or more of the following forms:
3479
3480@table @code
3481@item #$@var{obj}
3482@itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
b39fc6f7
LC
3483Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
3484supported types, for example a package or a
21b679f6
LC
3485derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
3486output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
3487
b39fc6f7
LC
3488If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
3489objects are substituted similarly.
21b679f6
LC
3490
3491If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
3492dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
3493
3494If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
3495
b39fc6f7
LC
3496@item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
3497@itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
21b679f6 3498This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
b39fc6f7
LC
3499@var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
3500multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
21b679f6 3501
667b2508
LC
3502@item #+@var{obj}
3503@itemx #+@var{obj}:output
3504@itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
3505@itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
3506Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
3507build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
3508
21b679f6
LC
3509@item #$output[:@var{output}]
3510@itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
3511Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
3512output when @var{output} is omitted.
3513
3514This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3515
3516@item #$@@@var{lst}
3517@itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
3518Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
3519containing list.
3520
667b2508
LC
3521@item #+@@@var{lst}
3522@itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
3523Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
3524@var{lst}.
3525
21b679f6
LC
3526@end table
3527
3528G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
3529of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
3530@end deffn
3531
3532@deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
3533Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
3534@end deffn
3535
3536G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
3537some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
3538below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
3539information about monads.)
3540
3541@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
ce45eb4c 3542 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
21b679f6
LC
3543 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3544 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
4684f301 3545 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
c8351d9a 3546 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
c0468155 3547 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
0309e1b0 3548 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
4a6aeb67 3549 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
21b679f6 3550Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
0309e1b0
LC
3551@var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
3552stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
3553it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
3554to by @var{exp}.
21b679f6 3555
ce45eb4c
LC
3556Make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
3557@var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
3558@var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
21b679f6
LC
3559the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
3560build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
3561
ce45eb4c
LC
3562@var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
3563applicable.
3564
b53833b2
LC
3565When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
3566following forms:
3567
3568@example
3569(@var{file-name} @var{package})
3570(@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
3571(@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
3572(@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
3573(@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
3574@end example
3575
3576The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
3577an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
3578@var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
3579text format.
3580
c8351d9a
LC
3581@var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
3582In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
3583refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
3584
e20fd1bf 3585The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
21b679f6
LC
3586@end deffn
3587
343eacbe 3588@cindex file-like objects
e1c153e0
LC
3589The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
3590@code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
3591@dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
3592these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
343eacbe
LC
3593
3594@example
3595#~(system* (string-append #$glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
3596 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
3597@end example
3598
3599The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
3600to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
3601@code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
3602@file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
3603does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
3604@code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
3605content is directly passed as a string.
3606
d9ae938f
LC
3607@deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3608 [#:recursive? #t]
3609Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
9d3994f7
LC
3610object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
3611up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
3612the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
d9ae938f
LC
3613
3614When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
3615designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
3616permission bits are kept.
3617
3618This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
3619procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
3620@end deffn
3621
558e8b11
LC
3622@deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
3623Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
3624@var{content} (a string) to be added to the store.
3625
3626This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
3627@end deffn
3628
91937029
LC
3629@deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
3630 [#:modules '()] [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
3631Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
3632directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{modules} specifies the set of
3633modules visible in the execution context of @var{gexp}. @var{options}
3634is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3635
3636This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
3637@end deffn
3638
21b679f6
LC
3639@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp}
3640Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
3641@var{guile} with @var{modules} in its search path.
3642
3643The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
3644command:
3645
3646@example
3647(use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
3648
3649(gexp->script "list-files"
3650 #~(execl (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
3651 "ls"))
3652@end example
3653
3654When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
e20fd1bf 3655@code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
21b679f6
LC
3656executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
3657
3658@example
3659#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
3660!#
3661(execl (string-append "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls")
3662 "ls")
3663@end example
3664@end deffn
3665
15a01c72
LC
3666@deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
3667 [#:modules '()] [#:guile #f]
3668Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
3669runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
3670script, and @var{modules} is the list of modules visible to that script.
3671
3672This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
3673@end deffn
3674
21b679f6
LC
3675@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp}
3676Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
3677
3678The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
3679or a subset thereof.
3680@end deffn
1ed19464 3681
e1c153e0
LC
3682@deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp}
3683Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
3684@var{exp}.
3685
3686This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
3687@end deffn
3688
1ed19464
LC
3689@deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
3690Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
3691containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
d9ae938f
LC
3692strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
3693derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
3694references to all these.
1ed19464
LC
3695
3696This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
3697to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
3698case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
3699like this:
3700
3701@example
3702(define (profile.sh)
3703 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
3704 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
3705 (text-file* "profile.sh"
3706 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
3707 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
3708@end example
3709
3710In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
3711will references @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
3712preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
3713@end deffn
21b679f6 3714
b751cde3
LC
3715@deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
3716Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
3717@var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
3718as in:
3719
3720@example
3721(mixed-text-file "profile"
3722 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
3723@end example
3724
3725This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
3726@end deffn
3727
21b679f6
LC
3728Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
3729also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
3730meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
3731@code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
3732
c2b84676
LC
3733@cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
3734Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
3735to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
3736yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
3737item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
3738
3739@deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
3740 [#:target #f]
3741Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
3742corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
3743@var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
3744has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
3745@end deffn
3746
21b679f6 3747
568717fd
LC
3748@c *********************************************************************
3749@node Utilities
3750@chapter Utilities
3751
210cc920
LC
3752This section describes tools primarily targeted at developers and users
3753who write new package definitions. They complement the Scheme
3754programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
3755
568717fd 3756@menu
37166310 3757* Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
39bee8a2 3758* Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
210cc920 3759* Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
37166310 3760* Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
2f7d2d91 3761* Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
37166310 3762* Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
b4f5e0e8 3763* Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
fcc58db6 3764* Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
88856916 3765* Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
372c4bbc 3766* Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
aff8ce7c 3767* Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
d23c20f1 3768* Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
32efa254 3769* Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
568717fd
LC
3770@end menu
3771
e49951eb
MW
3772@node Invoking guix build
3773@section Invoking @command{guix build}
568717fd 3774
e49951eb 3775The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
6798a8e4
LC
3776their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
3777does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
e49951eb 3778@command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
6798a8e4
LC
3779it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
3780
3781The general syntax is:
c78bd12b
LC
3782
3783@example
e49951eb 3784guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
c78bd12b
LC
3785@end example
3786
ccd7158d
LC
3787As an example, the following command builds the latest version of Emacs
3788and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
3789resulting directories:
3790
3791@example
3792guix build emacs guile
3793@end example
3794
3795Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
3796
3797@example
3798guix build --keep-going \
3799 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
3800@end example
3801
c78bd12b 3802@var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
5401dd75
LC
3803the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
3804@code{coreutils-8.20}, or a derivation such as
834129e0 3805@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
e7f34eb0
LC
3806package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
3807for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3808
3809Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
3810Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
3811disambiguation among several same-named packages or package variants is
3812needed.
c78bd12b 3813
ccd7158d
LC
3814There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
3815described in the subsections below.
3816
3817@menu
3818* Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
88ad6ded 3819* Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
ccd7158d
LC
3820* Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
3821@end menu
3822
3823@node Common Build Options
3824@subsection Common Build Options
3825
3826A number of options that control the build process are common to
3827@command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
3828@command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
3829following:
3830
3831@table @code
3832
3833@item --load-path=@var{directory}
3834@itemx -L @var{directory}
3835Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
3836(@pxref{Package Modules}).
3837
3838This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
3839the command-line tools.
3840
3841@item --keep-failed
3842@itemx -K
3843Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fail, its build
3844tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
3845the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
3846
3847@item --keep-going
3848@itemx -k
3849Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
3850all the builds have either completed or failed.
3851
3852The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
3853derivations has failed.
3854
3855@item --dry-run
3856@itemx -n
3857Do not build the derivations.
3858
3859@item --fallback
3860When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
3861packages locally.
3862
3863@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
3864@anchor{client-substitute-urls}
3865Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
3866URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
3867(@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
3868
3869This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
3870they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
3871(@pxref{Substitutes}).
3872
3873@item --no-substitutes
3874Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
3875locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
3876(@pxref{Substitutes}).
3877
3878@item --rounds=@var{n}
3879Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
3880consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
3881
3882This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
3883Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
3884practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
3885binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
3886
3887Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
3888so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
3889stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export},
3890then rebuilding, and finally comparing the two results.
3891
3892@item --no-build-hook
3893Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the daemon's ``build hook''
3894(@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
3895instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
3896
3897@item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
3898When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
3899@var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
3900
3901@item --timeout=@var{seconds}
3902Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
3903@var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
3904
3905By default there is no timeout. This behavior can be restored with
3906@code{--timeout=0}.
3907
3908@item --verbosity=@var{level}
3909Use the given verbosity level. @var{level} must be an integer between 0
3910and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of 4 or more
3911may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
3912
3913@item --cores=@var{n}
3914@itemx -c @var{n}
3915Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
3916value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
3917
3918@item --max-jobs=@var{n}
3919@itemx -M @var{n}
3920Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
3921guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
3922equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
3923
3924@end table
3925
3926Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
3927the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
3928module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
3929derivations)} module.
3930
3931In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
3932@command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
3933building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
3934
3935@defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
3936Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
3937will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
3938@command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
3939below:
3940
3941@example
3942$ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
3943@end example
3944
3945These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
3946the parsed command-line options.
3947@end defvr
3948
88ad6ded
LC
3949
3950@node Package Transformation Options
3951@subsection Package Transformation Options
3952
3953@cindex package variants
3954Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
b8638f03
LC
3955and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
3956options}. These are options that allow you to define @dfn{package
3957variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
3958This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
3959without having to type in the definitions of package variants
3960(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
88ad6ded
LC
3961
3962@table @code
3963
3964@item --with-source=@var{source}
3965Use @var{source} as the source of the corresponding package.
3966@var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
3967download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
3968
3969The ``corresponding package'' is taken to be one specified on the
3970command line whose name matches the base of @var{source}---e.g., if
3971@var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
3972package is @code{guile}. Likewise, the version string is inferred from
3973@var{source}; in the previous example, it's @code{2.0.10}.
3974
3975This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
3976one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
3977@file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
3978the @code{ed} package:
3979
3980@example
3981guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
3982@end example
3983
3984As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
3985candidates:
3986
3987@example
3988guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
3989@end example
3990
3991@dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
3992
3993@example
3994$ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
3995$ guix build guix --with-source=./guix
3996@end example
3997
47c0f92c
LC
3998@item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
3999Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
4000@var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
4001@var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
4002or @code{guile@@1.8}.
4003
4004For instance, the following command builds Guix but replaces its
4005dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
4006the development version of Guile, @code{guile-next}:
4007
4008@example
4009guix build --with-input=guile=guile-next guix
4010@end example
4011
4012This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
4013@code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
4014@code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile-next}.
4015
4016However, implicit inputs are left unchanged.
88ad6ded
LC
4017@end table
4018
ccd7158d
LC
4019@node Additional Build Options
4020@subsection Additional Build Options
4021
4022The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
4023build}.
c78bd12b
LC
4024
4025@table @code
4026
34a1783f
DT
4027@item --file=@var{file}
4028@itemx -f @var{file}
4029
4030Build the package or derivation that the code within @var{file}
4031evaluates to.
4032
4033As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
4034(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4035
4036@example
4037@verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
4038@end example
4039
c78bd12b
LC
4040@item --expression=@var{expr}
4041@itemx -e @var{expr}
ac5de156 4042Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
c78bd12b 4043
5401dd75 4044For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
c78bd12b
LC
4045guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
4046version 1.8 of Guile.
4047
56b82106
LC
4048Alternately, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
4049as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
4050(@pxref{G-Expressions}).
4051
4052Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
ac5de156
LC
4053(@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
4054monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
4055
c78bd12b
LC
4056@item --source
4057@itemx -S
4058Build the packages' source derivations, rather than the packages
4059themselves.
4060
e49951eb 4061For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
834129e0 4062@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is GCC's source tarball.
c78bd12b 4063
f9cc8971
LC
4064The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
4065code snippets specified in the package's @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
4066Packages}).
4067
2cdfe13d
EB
4068@item --sources
4069Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
4070dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
4071of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
4072eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
4073of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
4074optional argument values:
4075
4076@table @code
4077@item package
4078This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
4079as the @code{--source} option.
4080
4081@item all
4082Build all packages' source derivations, including any source that might
4083be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
4084
4085@example
4086$ guix build --sources tzdata
4087The following derivations will be built:
4088 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
4089 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4090@end example
4091
4092@item transitive
4093Build all packages' source derivations, as well as all source
4094derivations for packages' transitive inputs. This can be used e.g. to
4095prefetch package source for later offline building.
4096
4097@example
4098$ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
4099The following derivations will be built:
4100 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4101 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
4102 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
4103 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
4104 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
4105 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
4106@dots{}
4107@end example
4108
4109@end table
4110
c78bd12b
LC
4111@item --system=@var{system}
4112@itemx -s @var{system}
4113Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4114the host's system type.
4115
4116An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
4117different personalities. For instance, passing
4118@code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system allows users
4119to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
4120
e55ec43d
LC
4121@item --target=@var{triplet}
4122@cindex cross-compilation
4123Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4124as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU
4125configuration triplets,, configure, GNU Configure and Build System}).
4126
a8d65643
LC
4127@anchor{build-check}
4128@item --check
4129@cindex determinism, checking
4130@cindex reproducibility, checking
4131Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
4132store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
4133identical.
4134
4135This mechanism allows you to check whether previously-installed
4136substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether a package's
4137build result is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
4138background information and tools.
4139
05962f29
LC
4140@item --no-grafts
4141Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
4142available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
4143information on grafts.
7f3673f2 4144
c78bd12b
LC
4145@item --derivations
4146@itemx -d
4147Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
4148packages.
4149
70ee5642
LC
4150@item --root=@var{file}
4151@itemx -r @var{file}
4152Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
4153collector root.
4154
4155@item --log-file
3f208ad7 4156Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
70ee5642
LC
4157@var{package-or-derivation}s, or raise an error if build logs are
4158missing.
4159
4160This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
4161instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
4162
4163@example
4164guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
4165guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
4166guix build --log-file guile
4167guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
4168@end example
4169
3f208ad7
LC
4170If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
4171passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
4172substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
70ee5642 4173
3f208ad7
LC
4174So for instance, let's say you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS
4175but you're actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
4176
4177@example
4178$ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
4179http://hydra.gnu.org/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
4180@end example
4181
4182You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
70ee5642
LC
4183@end table
4184
16eb115e 4185
39bee8a2
LC
4186@node Invoking guix edit
4187@section Invoking @command{guix edit}
4188
4189@cindex package definition, editing
4190So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
4191facilitates the life of packagers by pointing their editor at the source
4192file containing the definition of the specified packages. For instance:
4193
4194@example
4195guix edit gcc-4.8 vim
4196@end example
4197
4198@noindent
6237b9fa
LC
4199launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
4200@code{EDITOR} environment variable to edit the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.8.4
4201and that of Vim.
39bee8a2
LC
4202
4203If you are using Emacs, note that the Emacs user interface provides
7c1b1ae2
AK
4204@kbd{M-x guix-edit} command and a similar functionality in the ``package
4205info'' and ``package list'' buffers created by @kbd{M-x
4206guix-search-by-name} and similar commands (@pxref{Emacs Commands}).
39bee8a2
LC
4207
4208
210cc920
LC
4209@node Invoking guix download
4210@section Invoking @command{guix download}
4211
4212When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
4213the package's source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
4214hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
4215@command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
4216from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
4217in the store and its SHA256 hash.
4218
4219The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
4220when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
4221with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
4222downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
4223convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
4224eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4225
4226The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
4227package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
4228@code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
4229Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
537c8bb3
LC
4230they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
4231how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
4232GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
210cc920
LC
4233
4234The following option is available:
4235
4236@table @code
4237@item --format=@var{fmt}
4238@itemx -f @var{fmt}
4239Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
081145cf 4240information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
210cc920
LC
4241@end table
4242
6c365eca
NK
4243@node Invoking guix hash
4244@section Invoking @command{guix hash}
4245
210cc920 4246The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
6c365eca
NK
4247It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
4248distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
4249used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4250
4251The general syntax is:
4252
4253@example
4254guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
4255@end example
4256
4257@command{guix hash} has the following option:
4258
4259@table @code
4260
4261@item --format=@var{fmt}
4262@itemx -f @var{fmt}
210cc920 4263Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
6c365eca
NK
4264
4265Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
4266(@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
4267
4268If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
4269will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
4270in the definitions of packages.
4271
3140f2df
LC
4272@item --recursive
4273@itemx -r
4274Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
4275
4276In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
4277including its children if it is a directory. Some of @var{file}'s
4278meta-data is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
4279regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
4280executable or not. Meta-data such as time stamps has no impact on the
4281hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
4282@c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
4283@c it exists.
4284
6c365eca
NK
4285@end table
4286
2f7d2d91
LC
4287@node Invoking guix import
4288@section Invoking @command{guix import}
4289
4290@cindex importing packages
4291@cindex package import
4292@cindex package conversion
4293The @command{guix import} command is useful for people willing to add a
4294package to the distribution but who'd rather do as little work as
4295possible to get there---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
4296repositories from which it can ``import'' package meta-data. The result
4297is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
4298(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4299
4300The general syntax is:
4301
4302@example
4303guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
4304@end example
4305
4306@var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
4307meta-data, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
4308options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
4309``importers'' are:
4310
4311@table @code
4312@item gnu
4313Import meta-data for the given GNU package. This provides a template
4314for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
4315source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
4316
4317Additional information such as the package's dependencies and its
4318license needs to be figured out manually.
4319
4320For example, the following command returns a package definition for
4321GNU@tie{}Hello:
4322
4323@example
4324guix import gnu hello
4325@end example
4326
4327Specific command-line options are:
4328
4329@table @code
4330@item --key-download=@var{policy}
4331As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
4332keys when verifying the package's signature. @xref{Invoking guix
4333refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
4334@end table
4335
4336@item pypi
4337@cindex pypi
4338Import meta-data from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
4339Index}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
4340@xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted
4341description available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all
4342the relevant information, including package dependencies.
4343
4344The command below imports meta-data for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
4345package:
4346
4347@example
4348guix import pypi itsdangerous
4349@end example
4350
3aae8145
DT
4351@item gem
4352@cindex gem
4353Import meta-data from @uref{https://rubygems.org/,
4354RubyGems}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be
4355installed. @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the
4356JSON-formatted description available at @code{rubygems.org} and includes
4357most relevant information, including runtime dependencies. There are
4358some caveats, however. The meta-data doesn't distinguish between
4359synopses and descriptions, so the same string is used for both fields.
4360Additionally, the details of non-Ruby dependencies required to build
4361native extensions is unavailable and left as an exercise to the
4362packager.
4363
4364The command below imports meta-data for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
4365
4366@example
4367guix import gem rails
4368@end example
4369
d45dc6da
EB
4370@item cpan
4371@cindex CPAN
4372Import meta-data from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
4373Information is taken from the JSON-formatted meta-data provided through
4374@uref{https://api.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
66392e47
EB
4375relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
4376should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
4377@code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
4378list of dependencies.
d45dc6da
EB
4379
4380The command command below imports meta-data for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
4381Perl module:
4382
4383@example
4384guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
4385@end example
4386
e1248602
RW
4387@item cran
4388@cindex CRAN
d0bd632f 4389@cindex Bioconductor
e1248602
RW
4390Import meta-data from @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
4391central repository for the @uref{http://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
4392statistical and graphical environment}.
4393
d0bd632f 4394Information is extracted from the package's @code{DESCRIPTION} file.
e1248602
RW
4395
4396The command command below imports meta-data for the @code{Cairo}
4397R package:
4398
4399@example
4400guix import cran Cairo
4401@end example
4402
d0bd632f
RW
4403When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, meta-data is imported from
4404@uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
4405packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
4406genomic data in bioinformatics.
4407
4408Information is extracted from a package's @code{DESCRIPTION} file
4409published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
4410
4411The command command below imports meta-data for the @code{GenomicRanges}
4412R package:
4413
4414@example
4415guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
4416@end example
4417
2f7d2d91
LC
4418@item nix
4419Import meta-data from a local copy of the source of the
4420@uref{http://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
4421relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
4422@uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
4423typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
4424command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
4425the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
4426package definition.
4427
4428When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
4429by their canonical upstream variant.
4430
961d0d2d
LC
4431Usually, you will first need to do:
4432
4433@example
4434export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
4435@end example
4436
4437@noindent
4438so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
4439
2f7d2d91
LC
4440As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
4441LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
4442bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
4443
4444@example
4445guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
4446@end example
863af4e1
FB
4447
4448@item hackage
4449@cindex hackage
4450Import meta-data from Haskell community's central package archive
4451@uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
4452Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
4453dependencies.
4454
4455Specific command-line options are:
4456
4457@table @code
a4154748
FB
4458@item --stdin
4459@itemx -s
4460Read a Cabal file from the standard input.
863af4e1
FB
4461@item --no-test-dependencies
4462@itemx -t
a4154748
FB
4463Do not include dependencies required by the test suites only.
4464@item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
4465@itemx -e @var{alist}
4466@var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
4467Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
4468@code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
4469The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
4470@code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
4471has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
4472associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
4473@samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc} respectively.
863af4e1
FB
4474@end table
4475
4476The command below imports meta-data for the latest version of the
a4154748
FB
4477@code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
4478specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
863af4e1
FB
4479
4480@example
a4154748 4481guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
863af4e1
FB
4482@end example
4483
4484A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
4485package name by a hyphen and a version number as in the following example:
4486
4487@example
4488guix import hackage mtl-2.1.3.1
4489@end example
7f74a931
FB
4490
4491@item elpa
4492@cindex elpa
4493Import meta-data from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
4494repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
4495
4496Specific command-line options are:
4497
4498@table @code
4499@item --archive=@var{repo}
4500@itemx -a @var{repo}
4501@var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
4502information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
4503are:
4504@itemize -
4505@item
840bd1d3 4506@uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
7f74a931
FB
4507identifier. This is the default.
4508
4509@item
840bd1d3 4510@uref{http://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
7f74a931
FB
4511@code{melpa-stable} identifier.
4512
4513@item
840bd1d3 4514@uref{http://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
7f74a931
FB
4515identifier.
4516@end itemize
4517@end table
2f7d2d91
LC
4518@end table
4519
4520The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
4521useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
4522is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
4523
37166310
LC
4524@node Invoking guix refresh
4525@section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
4526
4527The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
4528of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
4529provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
4530upstream version, like this:
4531
4532@example
4533$ guix refresh
4534gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
4535gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
4536@end example
4537
4538It does so by browsing each package's FTP directory and determining the
bcb571cb
LC
4539highest version number of the source tarballs therein. The command
4540knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
4541packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. The
4542are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
4543whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
4544extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
37166310
LC
4545
4546When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
4547update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those packages'
4548recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
4549each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
4550signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
4551using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
4552key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
4553attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
4554when it's successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
4555@command{guix refresh} reports an error.
4556
4557The following options are supported:
4558
4559@table @code
4560
2d7fc7da
LC
4561@item --expression=@var{expr}
4562@itemx -e @var{expr}
4563Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4564
4565This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
4566
4567@example
4568guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
4569@end example
4570
4571This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
4572the packages.)
4573
37166310
LC
4574@item --update
4575@itemx -u
38e16b49
LC
4576Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
4577usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
4578Guix Before It Is Installed}):
4579
4580@example
4581$ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core
4582@end example
4583
081145cf 4584@xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
37166310
LC
4585
4586@item --select=[@var{subset}]
4587@itemx -s @var{subset}
4588Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
4589@code{non-core}.
4590
4591The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
4592distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
4593else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
4594changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
4595all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
4596terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
4597
4598The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
4599typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
4600inconvenient.
4601
bcb571cb
LC
4602@item --type=@var{updater}
4603@itemx -t @var{updater}
7191adc5
AK
4604Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
4605list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
bcb571cb
LC
4606
4607@table @code
4608@item gnu
4609the updater for GNU packages;
e80c0f85
LC
4610@item gnome
4611the updater for GNOME packages;
bcb571cb 4612@item elpa
d882c235
LC
4613the updater for @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
4614@item cran
b9d044ef 4615the updater for @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
d0bd632f
RW
4616@item bioconductor
4617the updater for @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
bab020d7 4618@item pypi
b9d044ef 4619the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
bcb571cb
LC
4620@end table
4621
4622For instance, the following commands only checks for updates of Emacs
d882c235 4623packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and updates of CRAN packages:
bcb571cb
LC
4624
4625@example
7191adc5 4626$ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
d882c235 4627gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
bcb571cb
LC
4628gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
4629@end example
4630
37166310
LC
4631@end table
4632
4633In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
4634names, as in this example:
4635
4636@example
38e16b49 4637$ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc-4.8.4
37166310
LC
4638@end example
4639
4640@noindent
4641The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
4642@code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
4643effect in this case.
4644
7d193ec3
EB
4645When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
4646convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
4647should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
4648be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
4649
4650@table @code
4651
6ffa706b
AK
4652@item --list-updaters
4653@itemx -L
4654List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
4655
7d193ec3
EB
4656@item --list-dependent
4657@itemx -l
4658List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
4659result of upgrading one or more packages.
4660
4661@end table
4662
4663Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
4664@emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
4665an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
4666
4667@example
7779ab61
LC
4668$ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
4669Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
4670hop-2.4.0 geiser-0.4 notmuch-0.18 mu-0.9.9.5 cflow-1.4 idutils-4.6 @dots{}
7d193ec3
EB
4671@end example
4672
4673The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
4674for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
4675
f9230085
LC
4676The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
4677
4678@table @code
4679
f9230085
LC
4680@item --gpg=@var{command}
4681Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
4682for in @code{$PATH}.
4683
2bc53ba9
LC
4684@item --key-download=@var{policy}
4685Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
4686of:
4687
4688@table @code
4689@item always
4690Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
4691to the user's GnuPG keyring.
4692
4693@item never
4694Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
4695
4696@item interactive
4697When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
4698the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
4699@end table
4700
4701@item --key-server=@var{host}
4702Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
4703
f9230085
LC
4704@end table
4705
b4f5e0e8
CR
4706@node Invoking guix lint
4707@section Invoking @command{guix lint}
4708The @command{guix lint} is meant to help package developers avoid common
873c4085
LC
4709errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on a
4710given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
4711definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
4712@code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
4713
4714@table @code
4715@item synopsis
4716@itemx description
4717Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
4718descriptions and synopses.
4719
4720@item inputs-should-be-native
4721Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
4722
4723@item source
4724@itemx home-page
50f5c46d 4725@itemx source-file-name
873c4085 4726Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
50f5c46d
EB
4727invalid. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g. is not
4728just a version number or ``git-checkout'', and should not have a
4729@code{file-name} declared (@pxref{origin Reference}).
40a7d4e5 4730
5432734b
LC
4731@item cve
4732Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
4733Exposures (CVE) database
4734@uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
4735NIST}.
4736
40a7d4e5
LC
4737@item formatting
4738Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
4739use of tabulations, etc.
873c4085 4740@end table
b4f5e0e8
CR
4741
4742The general syntax is:
4743
4744@example
4745guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4746@end example
4747
4748If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
4749The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
4750
4751@table @code
4752
dd7c013d
CR
4753@item --checkers
4754@itemx -c
4755Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
4756names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
4757
b4f5e0e8
CR
4758@item --list-checkers
4759@itemx -l
4760List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
4761and exit.
4762
4763@end table
37166310 4764
fcc58db6
LC
4765@node Invoking guix size
4766@section Invoking @command{guix size}
4767
4768The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
4769disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
4770additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
4771single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
4772with Multiple Outputs}). These are the typical issues that
4773@command{guix size} can highlight.
4774
4775The command can be passed a package specification such as @code{gcc-4.8}
4776or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
4777example:
4778
4779@example
4780$ guix size coreutils
4781store item total self
4782/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23 70.0 13.9 19.8%
4783/gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.0.0a 55.3 2.5 3.6%
4784/gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 53.7 0.5 0.7%
4785/gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.46 53.2 0.3 0.5%
4786/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.4-lib 52.9 15.7 22.4%
4787/gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.21 37.2 37.2 53.1%
4788@end example
4789
4790@cindex closure
4791The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
4792Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
4793would be returned by:
4794
4795@example
4796$ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
4797@end example
4798
4799Here the output shows 3 columns next to store items. The first column,
4800labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
4801the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
4802dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
4803item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the item's size to the
4804space occupied by all the items listed here.
4805
4806In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
480770@tie{}MiB, half of which is taken by libc. (That libc represents a
4808large fraction of the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because it is
4809always available on the system anyway.)
4810
4811When the package passed to @command{guix size} is available in the
4812store, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
4813dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
4814-ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
4815Coreutils}).
4816
4817When the given package is @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
4818reports information based on information about the available substitutes
4819(@pxref{Substitutes}). This allows it to profile disk usage of store
4820items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
4821
a8f996c6 4822The available options are:
fcc58db6
LC
4823
4824@table @option
4825
d490d06e
LC
4826@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
4827Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
4828@xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
4829
a8f996c6
LC
4830@item --map-file=@var{file}
4831Write to @var{file} a graphical map of disk usage as a PNG file.
4832
4833For the example above, the map looks like this:
4834
4835@image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
4836produced by @command{guix size}}
4837
4838This option requires that
4839@uref{http://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
4840installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
4841the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
4842
fcc58db6
LC
4843@item --system=@var{system}
4844@itemx -s @var{system}
4845Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
4846
4847@end table
4848
88856916
LC
4849@node Invoking guix graph
4850@section Invoking @command{guix graph}
4851
4852@cindex DAG
4853Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
4854directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
4855mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command is
4856here to provide a visual representation of the DAG. @command{guix
4857graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
4858@uref{http://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
4859directly to Graphviz's @command{dot} command, for instance. The general
4860syntax is:
4861
4862@example
4863guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4864@end example
4865
4866For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
4867package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
4868dependencies:
4869
4870@example
4871guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
4872@end example
4873
4874The output looks like this:
4875
4876@image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
4877
4878Nice little graph, no?
4879
4880But there's more than one graph! The one above is concise: it's the
4881graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
4882grep, etc. It's often useful to have such a concise graph, but
4883sometimes you want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
4884several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of details:
4885
4886@table @code
4887@item package
4888This is the default type, the one we used above. It shows the DAG of
4889package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
4890filters out many details.
4891
4892@item bag-emerged
4893This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
4894
4895For instance, the following command:
4896
4897@example
4898guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
4899@end example
4900
4901... yields this bigger graph:
4902
4903@image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
4904
4905At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
4906@var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
4907
4908Now, note that the dependencies of those implicit inputs---that is, the
4909@dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
4910here, for conciseness.
4911
4912@item bag
4913Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
4914dependencies.
4915
38b92daa
LC
4916@item bag-with-origins
4917Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
4918
88856916
LC
4919@item derivations
4920This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
4921derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
4922the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
4923builds scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
4924
4925@end table
4926
4927All the above types correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
4928following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
4929
4930@table @code
4931@item references
4932This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
4933by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4934
4935If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
4936graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
4937@end table
4938
4939The available options are the following:
4940
4941@table @option
4942@item --type=@var{type}
4943@itemx -t @var{type}
4944Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
4945the values listed above.
4946
4947@item --list-types
4948List the supported graph types.
4c8f997a
LC
4949
4950@item --expression=@var{expr}
4951@itemx -e @var{expr}
4952Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4953
4954This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
4955
4956@example
4957guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
4958@end example
88856916
LC
4959@end table
4960
4961
372c4bbc
DT
4962@node Invoking guix environment
4963@section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4964
f5fd4fd2 4965@cindex reproducible build environments
fe36d84e 4966@cindex development environments
372c4bbc
DT
4967The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4968creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4969package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4970packages, builds all of the necessary inputs, and creates a shell
4971environment to use them.
4972
4973The general syntax is:
4974
4975@example
4976guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4977@end example
4978
fe36d84e
LC
4979The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4980GNU@tie{}Guile:
372c4bbc
DT
4981
4982@example
4983guix environment guile
4984@end example
4985
4986If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4987automatically builds them. The new shell's environment is an augmented
4988version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4989It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4990added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4991environment in which the original environment variables have been unset,
50500f7c
LC
4992use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4993environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4994file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4995may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4996environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4997variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4998@file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4999@xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
5000details on Bash start-up files.}.
372c4bbc 5001
28de8d25
LC
5002@vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5003@command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5004variable in the shell it spaws. This allows users to, say, define a
5005specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5006(@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5007
5008@example
5009if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5010then
5011 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5012fi
5013@end example
5014
372c4bbc
DT
5015Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5016union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5017command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5018and Emacs are available:
5019
5020@example
5021guix environment guile emacs
5022@end example
5023
1de2fe95
DT
5024Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5025command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5026command from the rest of the arguments:
372c4bbc
DT
5027
5028@example
1de2fe95 5029guix environment guile -- make -j4
372c4bbc
DT
5030@end example
5031
fe36d84e
LC
5032In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5033packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5034runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5035NumPy:
5036
5037@example
1de2fe95 5038guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
fe36d84e
LC
5039@end example
5040
cc90fbbf
DT
5041Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5042additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5043are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5044@code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5045@code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5046added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5047packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5048the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5049additionally includes Git and strace:
5050
5051@example
5052guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
5053@end example
5054
f535dcbe
DT
5055Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5056possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5057using Guix on a host distro that is not GuixSD, it is desirable to
5058prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5059the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5060a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5061working directory are mounted:
5062
5063@example
5064guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5065@end example
5066
0f252e26 5067@quotation Note
cfd35b4e 5068The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
0f252e26
DT
5069@end quotation
5070
fe36d84e 5071The available options are summarized below.
372c4bbc
DT
5072
5073@table @code
5074@item --expression=@var{expr}
5075@itemx -e @var{expr}
c9c282ce
DT
5076Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5077@var{expr} evaluates to.
372c4bbc 5078
fe36d84e
LC
5079For example, running:
5080
5081@example
5082guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5083@end example
5084
5085starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5086PETSc package.
5087
c9c282ce
DT
5088Running:
5089
5090@example
5c2b2f00 5091guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
c9c282ce
DT
5092@end example
5093
5094starts a shell with all the GuixSD base packages available.
5095
372c4bbc
DT
5096@item --load=@var{file}
5097@itemx -l @var{file}
c9c282ce
DT
5098Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5099within @var{file} evaluates to.
372c4bbc 5100
fe36d84e
LC
5101As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5102(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5103
5104@example
5105@verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5106@end example
5107
a54bd6d7
DT
5108@item --ad-hoc
5109Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5110@i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5111useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5112package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5113
5114For instance, the command:
5115
5116@example
1de2fe95 5117guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
a54bd6d7
DT
5118@end example
5119
5120runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5121available.
5122
417c39f1
LC
5123Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5124@code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl} but it is possible to ask for a
5125specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5126of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5127
cc90fbbf
DT
5128This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5129environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
5130as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
5131default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
5132that will be added to the environment directly.
5133
372c4bbc
DT
5134@item --pure
5135Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment.
5136This has the effect of creating an environment in which search paths
5137only contain package inputs.
5138
5139@item --search-paths
5140Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5141environment.
ce367ef3
LC
5142
5143@item --system=@var{system}
5144@itemx -s @var{system}
5145Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
f535dcbe
DT
5146
5147@item --container
5148@itemx -C
5149@cindex container
5150Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
56b6befb 5151directory outside the container is mapped inside the
f535dcbe
DT
5152container. Additionally, the spawned process runs as the current user
5153outside the container, but has root privileges in the context of the
5154container.
5155
5156@item --network
5157@itemx -N
5158For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5159Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5160device.
5161
5162@item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5163For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
5164as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
5165@var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5166point in the container.
5167
5168The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5169home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5170directory:
5171
5172@example
5173guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5174@end example
5175
5c2b2f00 5176@item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
f535dcbe
DT
5177For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
5178as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
5179@var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5180point in the container.
5181
5182The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5183home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
5184@file{/exchange} directory:
5185
5186@example
5187guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5188@end example
372c4bbc
DT
5189@end table
5190
5191It also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
ccd7158d 5192build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
372c4bbc 5193
aff8ce7c
DT
5194@node Invoking guix publish
5195@section Invoking @command{guix publish}
5196
5197The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
8ce229fc
LC
5198their store with others, which can then use it as a substitute server
5199(@pxref{Substitutes}).
5200
5201When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
5202anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
5203that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
5204since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
5205the @code{hydra.gnu.org} build farm.
aff8ce7c
DT
5206
5207For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
5208their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
5209@command{guix publish} uses the system's signing key, which is only
5463fe51
LC
5210readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
5211@code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
aff8ce7c 5212
b18812b6
LC
5213The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
5214launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
5215guix archive}).
5216
aff8ce7c
DT
5217The general syntax is:
5218
5219@example
5220guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
5221@end example
5222
5223Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
5224spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
5225
5226@example
5227guix publish
5228@end example
5229
5230Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
5231archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
5232
5233@example
5234guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
5235@end example
5236
5237The following options are available:
5238
5239@table @code
5240@item --port=@var{port}
5241@itemx -p @var{port}
5242Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
5243
9e2292ef
LC
5244@item --listen=@var{host}
5245Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
5246accept connections from any interface.
5247
5463fe51
LC
5248@item --user=@var{user}
5249@itemx -u @var{user}
5250Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
5251server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
5252
aff8ce7c
DT
5253@item --repl[=@var{port}]
5254@itemx -r [@var{port}]
5255Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
8ce229fc
LC
5256Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
5257primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
aff8ce7c
DT
5258@end table
5259
1c52181f
LC
5260Enabling @command{guix publish} on a GuixSD system is a one-liner: just
5261add a call to @code{guix-publish-service} in the @code{services} field
5262of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service,
5263@code{guix-publish-service}}).
5264
d23c20f1
LC
5265
5266@node Invoking guix challenge
5267@section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
5268
5269@cindex reproducible builds
5270@cindex verifiable builds
5271
5272Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
5273code it claims to build? Is this package's build process deterministic?
5274These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
5275answer.
5276
5277The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
5278server (@pxref{Substitutes}), you'd rather @emph{verify} that it
5279provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
5280is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
5281independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
5282bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
5283obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
5284
5285We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
5286the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
5287directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
5288etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
5289one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
5290@command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
5291mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
5292any given store item.
5293
5294The command's output looks like this:
5295
5296@smallexample
5297$ guix challenge --substitute-urls="http://hydra.gnu.org http://guix.example.org"
5298updating list of substitutes from 'http://hydra.gnu.org'... 100.0%
5299updating list of substitutes from 'http://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
5300/gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
5301 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5302 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5303 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
5304/gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
5305 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
5306 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
5307 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
5308/gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
5309 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5310 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5311 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
5312@end smallexample
5313
5314@noindent
5315In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
5316determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
5317items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
5318all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
5319the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
5320
5321@cindex non-determinism, in package builds
5322As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
5323Conversely, @code{hydra.gnu.org} agrees with local builds, except in the
5324case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
5325non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
5326various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
5327packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
5328sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
5329results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
5330by inode number. See @uref{http://reproducible.debian.net/howto/}, for
5331more information.
5332
5333To find out what's wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
5334these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
5335
5336@example
5337$ wget -q -O - http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
5338 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
043f4698 5339$ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
d23c20f1
LC
5340@end example
5341
5342This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
5343local build, and the files resulting from the build on
5344@code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
5345diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
5346works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
5347is @uref{http://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
5348visualize differences for all kinds of files.
5349
5350Once you've done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
5351to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
5352hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
5353to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process, one that
5354involves not just Guix but a large part of the free software community.
5355In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
5356the problem.
5357
5358If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
5359whether @code{hydra.gnu.org} and other substitute servers obtain the
5360same build result as you did with:
5361
5362@example
5363$ guix challenge @var{package}
5364@end example
5365
5366@noindent
5367... where @var{package} is a package specification such as
5368@code{guile-2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
5369
5370The general syntax is:
5371
5372@example
5373guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
5374@end example
5375
5376The one option that matters is:
5377
5378@table @code
5379
5380@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5381Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
5382URLs to compare to.
5383
5384@end table
5385
5386
32efa254
DT
5387@node Invoking guix container
5388@section Invoking @command{guix container}
5389@cindex container
5390
5391@quotation Note
5392As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
5393is subject to radical change in the future.
5394@end quotation
5395
5396The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
5397running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
46c36586 5398``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
32efa254
DT
5399(@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
5400(@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
5401
5402The general syntax is:
5403
5404@example
5405guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
5406@end example
5407
5408@var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
5409@var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
5410
5411The following actions are available:
5412
5413@table @code
5414@item exec
5415Execute a command within the context of a running container.
5416
5417The syntax is:
5418
5419@example
5420guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
5421@end example
5422
5423@var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
5424@var{program} specifies an executable file name within the container's
5425root file system. @var{arguments} are the additional options that will
5426be passed to @var{program}.
5427
5428The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
5429GuixSD container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
5430process ID is 9001:
5431
5432@example
5433guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
5434@end example
5435
5436Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
5437must be the container's PID 1 or one of its child processes.
5438
5439@end table
5440
a1ba8475
LC
5441@c *********************************************************************
5442@node GNU Distribution
5443@chapter GNU Distribution
5444
3ca2731c 5445@cindex Guix System Distribution
4705641f 5446@cindex GuixSD
3ca2731c
LC
5447Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
5448free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
a1ba8475 5449@url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
3ca2731c 5450users of that software}.}. The
35ed9306
LC
5451distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
5452but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
5453an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). To distinguish
3ca2731c 5454between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as the Guix
4705641f 5455System Distribution, or GuixSD.
35ed9306
LC
5456
5457The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
5458Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
5459list of available packages can be browsed
093ae1be 5460@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
d03bb653 5461running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
a1ba8475
LC
5462
5463@example
e49951eb 5464guix package --list-available
a1ba8475
LC
5465@end example
5466
35ed9306 5467Our goal has been to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
401c53c4
LC
5468Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
5469tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
5470tools that help users exert that freedom.
5471
3ca2731c 5472Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
c320011d
LC
5473
5474@table @code
5475
5476@item x86_64-linux
5477Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
5478
5479@item i686-linux
5480Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
5481
aa1e1947 5482@item armhf-linux
aa725117 5483ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
aa1e1947
MW
5484using the EABI hard-float ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
5485
c320011d
LC
5486@item mips64el-linux
5487little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
5488n32 application binary interface (ABI), and Linux-Libre kernel.
5489
5490@end table
5491
4705641f 5492GuixSD itself is currently only available on @code{i686} and @code{x86_64}.
3ca2731c 5493
c320011d
LC
5494@noindent
5495For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
5496@xref{Porting}.
5497
401c53c4 5498@menu
5af6de3e 5499* System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
35ed9306 5500* System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
91ef73d4 5501* Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
05962f29 5502* Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
401c53c4 5503* Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
da7cabd4 5504* Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
401c53c4 5505* Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
8b315a6d 5506* Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
401c53c4
LC
5507@end menu
5508
5509Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
081145cf 5510to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
401c53c4 5511
5af6de3e
LC
5512@node System Installation
5513@section System Installation
5514
3ca2731c
LC
5515@cindex Guix System Distribution
5516This section explains how to install the Guix System Distribution
5517on a machine. The Guix package manager can
35ed9306
LC
5518also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
5519@pxref{Installation}.
5af6de3e
LC
5520
5521@ifinfo
5522@c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
5523@c installation image.
5524You're reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
5525how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
6621cdb6 5526link that follows: @pxref{Help,,, info, Info: An Introduction}. Hit
5af6de3e
LC
5527@kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
5528@end ifinfo
5529
8aaaae38
LC
5530@subsection Limitations
5531
4705641f 5532As of version @value{VERSION}, the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD) is
3ca2731c 5533not production-ready. It may contain bugs and lack important
8aaaae38
LC
5534features. Thus, if you are looking for a stable production system that
5535respects your freedom as a computer user, a good solution at this point
5536is to consider @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-distros.html, one of
5537more established GNU/Linux distributions}. We hope you can soon switch
4705641f 5538to the GuixSD without fear, of course. In the meantime, you can
8aaaae38
LC
5539also keep using your distribution and try out the package manager on top
5540of it (@pxref{Installation}).
5541
5542Before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the following
5543noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
5544
5545@itemize
5546@item
5547The installation process does not include a graphical user interface and
5548requires familiarity with GNU/Linux (see the following subsections to
5549get a feel of what that means.)
5550
5551@item
093ae1be
LC
5552The system does not yet provide full GNOME and KDE desktops. Xfce and
5553Enlightenment are available though, if graphical desktop environments
5554are your thing, as well as a number of X11 window managers.
8aaaae38
LC
5555
5556@item
dbcb0ab1 5557Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
8aaaae38
LC
5558
5559@item
5560Few system services are currently supported out-of-the-box
5561(@pxref{Services}).
5562
5563@item
093ae1be 5564More than 2,000 packages are available, but you may
8aaaae38
LC
5565occasionally find that a useful package is missing.
5566@end itemize
5567
5568You've been warned. But more than a disclaimer, this is an invitation
5569to report issues (and success stories!), and join us in improving it.
5570@xref{Contributing}, for more info.
5af6de3e
LC
5571
5572@subsection USB Stick Installation
5573
5574An installation image for USB sticks can be downloaded from
4705641f 5575@indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz},
5af6de3e
LC
5576where @var{system} is one of:
5577
5578@table @code
5579@item x86_64-linux
5580for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
5581
5582@item i686-linux
5583for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
5584@end table
5585
5586This image contains a single partition with the tools necessary for an
5587installation. It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough
5588USB stick.
5589
5590To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
5591
5592@enumerate
5593@item
5594Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
5595
5596@example
4705641f 5597xz -d guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz
5af6de3e
LC
5598@end example
5599
5600@item
5601Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more in your machine, and determine
5602its device name. Assuming that USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
5603copy the image with:
5604
5605@example
4705641f 5606dd if=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64 of=/dev/sdX
5af6de3e
LC
5607@end example
5608
5609Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
5610@end enumerate
5611
5612Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
5613the USB stick. The latter usually requires you to get in the BIOS' boot
5614menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
5615
5616@subsection Preparing for Installation
5617
5618Once you have successfully booted the image on the USB stick, you should
5619end up with a root prompt. Several console TTYs are configured and can
5620be used to run commands as root. TTY2 shows this documentation,
5621browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Help,,, info, Info: An
ae7ffa9e
LC
5622Introduction}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
5623which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste
5624it with the middle button.
5af6de3e
LC
5625
5626To install the system, you would:
5627
5628@enumerate
5629
5630@item
235cba85
LC
5631Configure the network, by running:
5632
5633@example
5634ifconfig eno1 up && dhclient eno1
5635@end example
5636
5637to get an automatically assigned IP address from the wired
152dd61c 5638network interface controller@footnote{
95c559c1
LC
5639@c http://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
5640The name @code{eno1} is for the first on-board Ethernet controller. The
5641interface name for an Ethernet controller that is in the first slot of
5642the first PCI bus, for instance, would be @code{enp1s0}. Use
235cba85 5643@command{ifconfig -a} to list all the available network interfaces.},
95c559c1 5644or using the @command{ifconfig} command.
5af6de3e
LC
5645
5646The system automatically loads drivers for your network interface
5647controllers.
5648
5649Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
5650image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
5651
5652@item
316d65be
LC
5653Unless this has already been done, you must partition, and then format
5654the target partition.
5af6de3e 5655
7ab44369
LC
5656Preferably, assign partitions a label so that you can easily and
5657reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
5658Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
5659@command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands.
5660
dd816355
LF
5661Be sure that your partition labels match the value of their respective
5662@code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, if your
5663@code{file-system} configuration sets the value of @code{title} to
5664@code{'label}, as do the example configurations found on the USB
5665installation image under @file{/etc/configuration} (@pxref{Using the
5666Configuration System}).
5667
316d65be
LC
5668@c FIXME: Uncomment this once GRUB fully supports encrypted roots.
5669@c A typical command sequence may be:
5670@c
5671@c @example
5672@c # fdisk /dev/sdX
5673@c @dots{} Create partitions etc.@dots{}
5674@c # cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sdX1
5675@c # cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sdX1 my-partition
5676@c # mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
5677@c @end example
6d6e6281 5678
5af6de3e 5679The installation image includes Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU
b419c7f5
LC
5680Parted User Manual}), @command{fdisk}, Cryptsetup/LUKS for disk
5681encryption, and e2fsprogs, the suite of tools to manipulate
5682ext2/ext3/ext4 file systems.
5af6de3e 5683
83a17b62
LC
5684@item
5685Once that is done, mount the target root partition under @file{/mnt}.
5686
5687@item
dd17bc38 5688Lastly, run @code{herd start cow-store /mnt}.
83a17b62
LC
5689
5690This will make @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added
5691to it during the installation phase will be written to the target disk
5692rather than kept in memory.
5693
5af6de3e
LC
5694@end enumerate
5695
5af6de3e
LC
5696
5697@subsection Proceeding with the Installation
5698
5699With the target partitions ready, you now have to edit a file and
5700provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
5701that end, the installation system comes with two text editors: GNU nano
5702(@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), and GNU Zile, an Emacs clone.
5703It is better to store that file on the target root file system, say, as
5704@file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}.
5705
dd51caac
LC
5706@xref{Using the Configuration System}, for examples of operating system
5707configurations. These examples are available under
5708@file{/etc/configuration} in the installation image, so you can copy
5709them and use them as a starting point for your own configuration.
5af6de3e 5710
dd51caac
LC
5711Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
5712be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
5713under @file{/mnt}):
5af6de3e
LC
5714
5715@example
5716guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
5717@end example
5718
5719@noindent
5720This will copy all the necessary files, and install GRUB on
5721@file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-grub} option. For
6621cdb6 5722more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
5af6de3e
LC
5723downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
5724
1bd4e6db
LC
5725Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
5726@command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
5727in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
5728initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
5729unless your configuration specifies otherwise
5730(@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
5731
5732Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
5af6de3e
LC
5733@file{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience---good or not so
5734good.
5735
5736@subsection Building the Installation Image
5737
5738The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
5739system} command, specifically:
5740
5741@example
8a225c66 5742guix system disk-image --image-size=850MiB gnu/system/install.scm
5af6de3e
LC
5743@end example
5744
5745@xref{Invoking guix system}, for more information. See
5746@file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree for more information
5747about the installation image.
5748
cf4a9129
LC
5749@node System Configuration
5750@section System Configuration
b208a005 5751
cf4a9129 5752@cindex system configuration
3ca2731c 5753The Guix System Distribution supports a consistent whole-system configuration
cf4a9129
LC
5754mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
5755configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
5756locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
5757a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
91ef73d4 5758
cf4a9129
LC
5759One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
5760control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
5761makes it possible to roll-back to a previous system instantiation,
5762should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
5763one is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
5764across different machines, or at different points in time, without
5765having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
5766the system's own tools.
5767@c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
91ef73d4 5768
cf4a9129
LC
5769This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
5770administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
5771instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
5772instance to support new system services.
91ef73d4 5773
cf4a9129
LC
5774@menu
5775* Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
7313a52e 5776* operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
cf4a9129 5777* File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
510f9d86 5778* Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
cf4a9129 5779* User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
598e19dc 5780* Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
cf4a9129 5781* Services:: Specifying system services.
0ae8c15a 5782* Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
efb5e833 5783* X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
996ed739 5784* Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
fd1b1fa2 5785* Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
88faf933 5786* GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
cf4a9129 5787* Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
97d76250 5788* Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
cf4a9129
LC
5789* Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
5790@end menu
91ef73d4 5791
cf4a9129
LC
5792@node Using the Configuration System
5793@subsection Using the Configuration System
64d76fa6 5794
cf4a9129
LC
5795The operating system is configured by providing an
5796@code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
5797the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
5798simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
5799kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
91ef73d4 5800
cf4a9129
LC
5801@findex operating-system
5802@lisp
dd51caac 5803@include os-config-bare-bones.texi
cf4a9129 5804@end lisp
401c53c4 5805
cf4a9129
LC
5806This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
5807above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
5808Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
5809which case they get a default value.
e7f34eb0 5810
5d94ac51
LC
5811Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
5812(@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
5813fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
5814@command{guix system}.
5815
5816@unnumberedsubsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
5817
cf4a9129 5818@vindex %base-packages
5d94ac51
LC
5819The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
5820on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
5821environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
5822(@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
5823provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
5824tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
5825the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
5826etc. The example above adds tcpdump to those, taken from the @code{(gnu
5827packages admin)} module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
e7f34eb0 5828
f6c9fb1b
LC
5829@findex specification->package
5830Referring to packages by variable name, like @var{tcpdump} above, has
5831the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
5832diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
5833needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
5834@code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
5835the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
5836module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
5837version:
5838
5839@lisp
5840(use-modules (gnu packages))
5841
5842(operating-system
5843 ;; ...
5844 (packages (append (map specification->package
5845 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg-2.0"))
5846 %base-packages)))
5847@end lisp
5848
5d94ac51
LC
5849@unnumberedsubsubsec System Services
5850
cf4a9129
LC
5851@vindex %base-services
5852The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
5853available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
5854The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
5855addition to the basic services, we want the @command{lshd} secure shell
cd6f6c22
LC
5856daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
5857@code{lsh-service}}). Under the hood,
cf4a9129
LC
5858@code{lsh-service} arranges so that @code{lshd} is started with the
5859right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
cd6f6c22
LC
5860generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
5861
5862@cindex customization, of services
5863@findex modify-services
5864Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
5865customize them. For instance, to change the configuration of
5866@code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty (the console log-in), you may write the
5867following instead of @var{%base-services}:
5868
5869@lisp
5870(modify-services %base-services
5871 (guix-service-type config =>
5872 (guix-configuration
5873 (inherit config)
5874 (use-substitutes? #f)
5875 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-outputs"))))
5876 (mingetty-service-type config =>
5877 (mingetty-configuration
5878 (inherit config)
5879 (motd (plain-file "motd" "Hi there!")))))
5880@end lisp
5881
5882@noindent
5883The effect here is to change the options passed to @command{guix-daemon}
5884when it is started, as well as the ``message of the day'' that appears
5885when logging in at the console. @xref{Service Reference,
5886@code{modify-services}}, for more on that.
a1ba8475 5887
dd51caac 5888The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with the X11 display
cd6f6c22 5889server, a desktop environment, network management, power management, and
dd51caac
LC
5890more, would look like this:
5891
5892@lisp
5893@include os-config-desktop.texi
5894@end lisp
5895
5896@xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
efb5e833
LC
5897@var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
5898information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
dd51caac 5899
5d94ac51
LC
5900Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
5901you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
5902procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
5903Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
5904following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
5905@var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
5906
5907@example
5908(remove (lambda (service)
5909 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
5910 %desktop-services)
5911@end example
5912
5913@unnumberedsubsubsec Instantiating the System
5914
5915Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
5916is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
cf4a9129
LC
5917file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
5918instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
65797bff
LC
5919entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
5920
5921The normal way to change the system's configuration is by updating this
5922file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
5923have to touch files in @command{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
5924system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
5925fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
5926but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
5927system, should you ever need to.
5928
5929@cindex roll-back, of the operating system
5930Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
5931reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
5932modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
5933an entry in the GRUB boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
5934something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
5935@command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
5936generations available on disk.
b81e1947 5937
5d94ac51
LC
5938@unnumberedsubsubsec The Programming Interface
5939
cf4a9129
LC
5940At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
5941is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
5942Monad}):
b81e1947 5943
cf4a9129
LC
5944@deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
5945Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
5946object (@pxref{Derivations}).
b81e1947 5947
cf4a9129
LC
5948The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
5949the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
5950instantiate @var{os}.
5951@end deffn
b81e1947 5952
5d94ac51
LC
5953This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
5954with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
5955guts of GuixSD. Make sure to visit it!
5956
5957
7313a52e
LC
5958@node operating-system Reference
5959@subsection @code{operating-system} Reference
5960
5961This section summarizes all the options available in
5962@code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
5963System}).
5964
5965@deftp {Data Type} operating-system
5966This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
5967By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
5968configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
5969
5970@table @asis
5971@item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
fbb25e56 5972The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
7313a52e
LC
5973only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
5974possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
5975
ee2a6304
LC
5976@item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5977List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
5978the kernel's command-line---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
5979
7313a52e 5980@item @code{bootloader}
88faf933 5981The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{GRUB Configuration}.
7313a52e
LC
5982
5983@item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
5984A two-argument monadic procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for
5985the Linux kernel. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
5986
f34c56be
LC
5987@item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
5988@cindex firmware
5989List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
5990
5991The default includes firmware needed for Atheros-based WiFi devices
5992(Linux-libre module @code{ath9k}.)
5993
7313a52e
LC
5994@item @code{host-name}
5995The host name.
5996
5997@item @code{hosts-file}
5998@cindex hosts file
24e02c28 5999A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
7313a52e 6000@file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
24e02c28 6001Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
7313a52e
LC
6002@code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
6003
6004@item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6005A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
6006
6007@item @code{file-systems}
6008A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
6009
6010@item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6011@cindex swap devices
6012A list of strings identifying devices to be used for ``swap space''
6013(@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6014For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")}.
6015
bf87f38a 6016@item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
7313a52e
LC
6017@itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
6018List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
6019
6020@item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
6021A monadic list of pairs of target file name and files. These are the
6022files that will be used as skeletons as new accounts are created.
6023
6024For instance, a valid value may look like this:
6025
6026@example
6027(mlet %store-monad ((bashrc (text-file "bashrc" "\
6028 export PATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/bin")))
6029 (return `((".bashrc" ,bashrc))))
6030@end example
6031
6032@item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
6033A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
6034what displayed when users log in on a text console.
6035
6036@item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
6037The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
6038at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
6039
6040The default set includes core utilities, but it is good practice to
6041install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
6042package}).
6043
6044@item @code{timezone}
6045A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
6046
17c20385
LC
6047You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
6048string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
6049causes @command{guix system} to fail.
6050
598e19dc
LC
6051@item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
6052The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
6053Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
6054
6055@item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
6056The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
6057run time. @xref{Locales}.
7313a52e 6058
34760ae7
LC
6059@item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
6060The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
6061to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
6062considerations that justify this option.
6063
996ed739
LC
6064@item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
6065Configuration of libc's name service switch (NSS)---a
6066@code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
6067details.
6068
7313a52e 6069@item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
28d939af 6070A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
7313a52e
LC
6071
6072@item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
6073@cindex PAM
6074@cindex pluggable authentication modules
6075Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
6076@c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
6077
6078@item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
6079List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
6080@xref{Setuid Programs}.
6081
f5a9ffa0
AK
6082@item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
6083@cindex sudoers file
84765839
LC
6084The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
6085(@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
7313a52e
LC
6086
6087This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
6088they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
6089is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
6090@code{sudo}.
6091
6092@end table
6093@end deftp
6094
cf4a9129
LC
6095@node File Systems
6096@subsection File Systems
b81e1947 6097
cf4a9129
LC
6098The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
6099@code{file-systems} field of the operating system's declaration
6100(@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
6101using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
b81e1947
LC
6102
6103@example
cf4a9129
LC
6104(file-system
6105 (mount-point "/home")
6106 (device "/dev/sda3")
6107 (type "ext4"))
b81e1947
LC
6108@end example
6109
cf4a9129
LC
6110As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
6111above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
b81e1947 6112
cf4a9129
LC
6113@deftp {Data Type} file-system
6114Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
6115contain the following members:
5ff3c4b8 6116
cf4a9129
LC
6117@table @asis
6118@item @code{type}
6119This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
6120@code{"ext4"}.
5ff3c4b8 6121
cf4a9129
LC
6122@item @code{mount-point}
6123This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
b81e1947 6124
cf4a9129
LC
6125@item @code{device}
6126This names the ``source'' of the file system. By default it is the name
6127of a node under @file{/dev}, but its meaning depends on the @code{title}
6128field described below.
401c53c4 6129
cf4a9129
LC
6130@item @code{title} (default: @code{'device})
6131This is a symbol that specifies how the @code{device} field is to be
6132interpreted.
401c53c4 6133
cf4a9129
LC
6134When it is the symbol @code{device}, then the @code{device} field is
6135interpreted as a file name; when it is @code{label}, then @code{device}
6136is interpreted as a partition label name; when it is @code{uuid},
6137@code{device} is interpreted as a partition unique identifier (UUID).
da7cabd4 6138
661a1d79
LC
6139UUIDs may be converted from their string representation (as shown by the
6140@command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form, like this:
6141
6142@example
6143(file-system
6144 (mount-point "/home")
6145 (type "ext4")
6146 (title 'uuid)
6147 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
6148@end example
6149
cf4a9129 6150The @code{label} and @code{uuid} options offer a way to refer to disk
661a1d79
LC
6151partitions without having to hard-code their actual device
6152name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
6153@file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
6154result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
6155by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
6156mounted.}.
da7cabd4 6157
5f86a66e
LC
6158However, when a file system's source is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
6159Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
6160device name---e.g., @file{/dev/mapper/root-partition}---and consequently
6161@code{title} must be set to @code{'device}. This is required so that
6162the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
6163corresponding device mapping established.
6164
cf4a9129
LC
6165@item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
6166This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
2c071ce9
LC
6167include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
6168access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
6169bits), and @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution.)
da7cabd4 6170
cf4a9129
LC
6171@item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
6172This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options.
da7cabd4 6173
be21979d
LC
6174@item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
6175This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
6176the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
6177an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
6178is not automatically mounted.
6179
cf4a9129
LC
6180@item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
6181This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
6182booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
6183initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
6184instance, for the root file system.
da7cabd4 6185
cf4a9129
LC
6186@item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
6187This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
6188errors before being mounted.
f9cc8971 6189
4e469051
LC
6190@item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
6191When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
6192
e51710d1
LC
6193@item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
6194This is a list of @code{<file-system>} objects representing file systems
6195that must be mounted before (and unmounted after) this one.
6196
6197As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
6198a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
6199@file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
6200
cf4a9129
LC
6201@end table
6202@end deftp
da7cabd4 6203
a69576ea
LC
6204The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
6205variables.
6206
6207@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
6208These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
cc0e575a 6209such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
3392ce5d
LC
6210below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
6211these.
a69576ea
LC
6212@end defvr
6213
7f239fd3
LC
6214@defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
6215This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
6216@dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
6217functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
6218Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
6219@command{xterm}.
6220@end defvr
6221
db17ae5c
LC
6222@defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
6223This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
6224memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
6225@code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6226@end defvr
6227
3392ce5d
LC
6228@defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
6229This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
6230@file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
6231@code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
6232running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
6233
6234The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
6235read-write in its own ``name space.''
6236@end defvr
6237
a69576ea
LC
6238@defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
6239The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
6240executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
6241@code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
6242@end defvr
6243
6244@defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
6245The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
6246and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
6247@code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
6248@end defvr
6249
510f9d86
LC
6250@node Mapped Devices
6251@subsection Mapped Devices
6252
6253@cindex device mapping
6254@cindex mapped devices
6255The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
6256such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
6257with additional processing over the data that flows through
6258it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
6259concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
6260to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
6261operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
6262devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
6263(@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
6264typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
6265device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
6266
6267Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form:
6268
6269@example
6270(mapped-device
6271 (source "/dev/sda3")
6272 (target "home")
6273 (type luks-device-mapping))
6274@end example
6275
6276@noindent
6277@cindex disk encryption
6278@cindex LUKS
6279This example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
6280@file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
6281@url{http://code.google.com/p/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
6282standard mechanism for disk encryption. The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
6283device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
6284declaration (@pxref{File Systems}). The @code{mapped-device} form is
6285detailed below.
6286
6287@deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
6288Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
6289the system boots up.
6290
9cb426b8
LC
6291@table @code
6292@item source
510f9d86
LC
6293This string specifies the name of the block device to be mapped, such as
6294@code{"/dev/sda3"}.
6295
9cb426b8 6296@item target
510f9d86
LC
6297This string specifies the name of the mapping to be established. For
6298example, specifying @code{"my-partition"} will lead to the creation of
6299the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
6300
9cb426b8 6301@item type
510f9d86
LC
6302This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
6303@var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
6304@end table
6305@end deftp
6306
6307@defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
6308This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
6309command, from the same-named package. This relies on the
6310@code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
6311@end defvr
6312
cf4a9129
LC
6313@node User Accounts
6314@subsection User Accounts
ee85f3db 6315
9bea87a5
LC
6316User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
6317@code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
6318@code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
ee85f3db 6319
cf4a9129
LC
6320@example
6321(user-account
6322 (name "alice")
6323 (group "users")
24e752c0
LC
6324 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
6325 "audio" ;sound card
6326 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
6327 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
cf4a9129
LC
6328 (comment "Bob's sister")
6329 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
6330@end example
25083588 6331
9bea87a5
LC
6332When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
6333the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
6334the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
6335properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
6336directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
6337reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
6338as declared.
6339
cf4a9129
LC
6340@deftp {Data Type} user-account
6341Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
6342be specified:
ee85f3db 6343
cf4a9129
LC
6344@table @asis
6345@item @code{name}
6346The name of the user account.
ee85f3db 6347
cf4a9129
LC
6348@item @code{group}
6349This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
6350this account belongs to.
ee85f3db 6351
cf4a9129
LC
6352@item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
6353Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
6354account belongs to.
ee85f3db 6355
cf4a9129
LC
6356@item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
6357This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
6358latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
6359account is created.
ee85f3db 6360
cf4a9129
LC
6361@item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
6362A comment about the account, such as the account's owner full name.
c8c871d1 6363
cf4a9129
LC
6364@item @code{home-directory}
6365This is the name of the home directory for the account.
ee85f3db 6366
cf4a9129
LC
6367@item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
6368This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
6369the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
ee85f3db 6370
cf4a9129
LC
6371@item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
6372This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
6373account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
6374graphical login managers do not list them.
ee85f3db 6375
1bd4e6db 6376@anchor{user-account-password}
cf4a9129 6377@item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
eb59595c
LC
6378You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
6379passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
9bea87a5
LC
6380users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
6381@command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
6382reconfiguration.
eb59595c
LC
6383
6384If you @emph{do} want to have a preset password for an account, then
6385this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string.
5d1f1177
LC
6386@xref{crypt,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for more information
6387on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
eb59595c 6388Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
c8c871d1 6389
cf4a9129
LC
6390@end table
6391@end deftp
ee85f3db 6392
cf4a9129 6393User group declarations are even simpler:
ee85f3db 6394
cf4a9129
LC
6395@example
6396(user-group (name "students"))
6397@end example
ee85f3db 6398
cf4a9129
LC
6399@deftp {Data Type} user-group
6400This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
af8a56b8 6401
cf4a9129
LC
6402@table @asis
6403@item @code{name}
6404The group's name.
ee85f3db 6405
cf4a9129
LC
6406@item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
6407The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
6408automatically allocated when the group is created.
ee85f3db 6409
c8fa3426
LC
6410@item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
6411This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
6412System groups have low numerical IDs.
6413
cf4a9129
LC
6414@item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
6415What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
6416@code{#f}, this field specifies the group's password.
ee85f3db 6417
cf4a9129
LC
6418@end table
6419@end deftp
401c53c4 6420
cf4a9129
LC
6421For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
6422expect:
401c53c4 6423
cf4a9129
LC
6424@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
6425This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
6426to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
6427``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
6428specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
6429@end defvr
401c53c4 6430
bf87f38a
LC
6431@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
6432This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
6433find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
6434
6435Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
6436special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
6437@end defvr
6438
598e19dc
LC
6439@node Locales
6440@subsection Locales
6441
6442@cindex locale
6443A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
6444and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6445Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
b2636518 6446@code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
598e19dc
LC
6447@code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
6448cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
6449
6450@cindex locale definition
6451Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
6452using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
6453(@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
6454
6455That locale must be among the @dfn{locale definitions} that are known to
6456the system---and these are specified in the @code{locale-definitions}
6457slot of @code{operating-system}. The default value includes locale
c4847f49 6458definitions for some widely used locales, but not for all the available
598e19dc
LC
6459locales, in order to save space.
6460
6461If the locale specified in the @code{locale} field is not among the
6462definitions listed in @code{locale-definitions}, @command{guix system}
6463raises an error. In that case, you should add the locale definition to
6464the @code{locale-definitions} field. For instance, to add the North
6465Frisian locale for Germany, the value of that field may be:
6466
6467@example
6468(cons (locale-definition
6469 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
6470 %default-locale-definitions)
6471@end example
6472
6473Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
6474list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
6475
6476@example
6477(list (locale-definition
6478 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
6479 (charset "EUC-JP")))
6480@end example
6481
5c3c1427
LC
6482@vindex LOCPATH
6483The compiled locale definitions are available at
46bd6edd
LC
6484@file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
6485version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
6486by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
6487@code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
5c3c1427
LC
6488@code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
6489
598e19dc
LC
6490The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
6491locale)} module. Details are given below.
6492
6493@deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
6494This is the data type of a locale definition.
6495
6496@table @asis
6497
6498@item @code{name}
6499The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6500Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
6501
6502@item @code{source}
6503The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
6504@code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
6505
6506@item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
6507The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
6508@uref{http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
6509IANA}.
6510
6511@end table
6512@end deftp
6513
6514@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
b2636518
LC
6515An arbitrary list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
6516value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
598e19dc 6517declarations.
b2636518
LC
6518
6519@cindex locale name
6520@cindex normalized codeset in locale names
6521These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
6522that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
6523normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
6524instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
6525@code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
598e19dc 6526@end defvr
401c53c4 6527
34760ae7
LC
6528@subsubsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
6529
6530@cindex incompatibility, of locale data
6531@code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
6532to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
6533declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
6534care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
6535locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
6536another.
6537
6538@c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
6539@c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
6540For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
6541read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
6542@emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
6543data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
6544the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
6545Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
6546all, the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
6547data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
6548programs will not abort.
6549
6550The ``problem'' in GuixSD is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
6551choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
6552be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
6553used to build the system-wide locale data.
6554
6555Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
6556and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
6557@code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
6558
6559Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
6560@file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
6561actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
6562it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
6563administrator can specify several libc packages in the
6564@code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
6565
6566@example
6567(use-package-modules base)
6568
6569(operating-system
6570 ;; @dots{}
6571 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
6572@end example
6573
6574This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
6575both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
6576@file{/run/current-system/locale}.
6577
6578
cf4a9129
LC
6579@node Services
6580@subsection Services
401c53c4 6581
cf4a9129
LC
6582@cindex system services
6583An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
6584listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
6585Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
6586when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
d8b94dbd
LC
6587configuring network access.
6588
dd17bc38
AK
6589Services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd (@pxref{Introduction,,,
6590shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). On a running system, the
6591@command{herd} command allows you to list the available services, show
6592their status, start and stop them, or do other specific operations
6593(@pxref{Jump Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
d8b94dbd
LC
6594
6595@example
dd17bc38 6596# herd status
d8b94dbd
LC
6597@end example
6598
6599The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
dd17bc38 6600services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
d8b94dbd
LC
6601service:
6602
6603@example
dd17bc38 6604# herd doc nscd
d8b94dbd
LC
6605Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
6606@end example
6607
6608The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
6609have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
6610the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
6611
6612@example
dd17bc38 6613# herd stop nscd
d8b94dbd 6614Service nscd has been stopped.
dd17bc38 6615# herd restart xorg-server
d8b94dbd
LC
6616Service xorg-server has been stopped.
6617Service xorg-server has been started.
6618@end example
401c53c4 6619
cf4a9129 6620The following sections document the available services, starting with
d8b94dbd
LC
6621the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
6622declaration.
401c53c4 6623
cf4a9129
LC
6624@menu
6625* Base Services:: Essential system services.
6626* Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
6627* X Window:: Graphical display.
fe1a39d3 6628* Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
105369a4 6629* Database Services:: SQL databases.
d8c18af8 6630* Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
58724c48 6631* Web Services:: Web servers.
aa4ed923 6632* Various Services:: Other services.
cf4a9129 6633@end menu
401c53c4 6634
cf4a9129
LC
6635@node Base Services
6636@subsubsection Base Services
a1ba8475 6637
cf4a9129
LC
6638The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
6639services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
6640this module are listed below.
401c53c4 6641
cf4a9129 6642@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
31771497
LC
6643This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
6644and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
cf4a9129
LC
6645expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
6646libc's name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
6647more.
401c53c4 6648
cf4a9129
LC
6649This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
6650@code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
6651system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
6652this:
401c53c4 6653
cf4a9129 6654@example
fa1e31b8 6655(cons* (avahi-service) (lsh-service) %base-services)
cf4a9129
LC
6656@end example
6657@end defvr
401c53c4 6658
be1c2c54 6659@deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
cf4a9129
LC
6660Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
6661@end deffn
401c53c4 6662
66e4f01c
LC
6663@deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
6664Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
6665@code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
6666other things.
cf4a9129 6667@end deffn
401c53c4 6668
66e4f01c
LC
6669@deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
6670This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
6671implements console log-in.
6672
6673@table @asis
6674
6675@item @code{tty}
6676The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
6677
6678@item @code{motd}
6679A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
6680
6681@item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
6682When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
f9b9a033 6683which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
66e4f01c
LC
6684user name and password must be entered to log in.
6685
6686@item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
6687This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
6688is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
6689the name of the log-in program.
6690
6691@item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
6692When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
6693will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
6694
6695@item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
6696The Mingetty package to use.
6697
6698@end table
6699@end deftp
6700
6454b333
LC
6701@cindex name service cache daemon
6702@cindex nscd
be1c2c54 6703@deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
4aee6e60 6704 [#:name-services '()]
b893f1ae
LC
6705Return a service that runs libc's name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
6706given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
6707Service Switch}, for an example.
cf4a9129 6708@end deffn
401c53c4 6709
6454b333
LC
6710@defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
6711This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
6712by @code{nscd-service}. This uses the caches defined by
6713@var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
6714@end defvr
6715
6716@deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
6717This is the type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
6718configuration.
6719
6720@table @asis
6721
b893f1ae
LC
6722@item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
6723List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
6724the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
6725
6726@item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
6727Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
6728command.
6729
6454b333
LC
6730@item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
6731Name of nscd's log file. This is where debugging output goes when
6732@code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
6733
6734@item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
6735Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean more
6736debugging output is logged.
6737
6738@item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
6739List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
6740below.
6741
6742@end table
6743@end deftp
6744
6745@deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
6746Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
6747
6748@table @asis
6749
6750@item @code{database}
6751This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
6752Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
6753@code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
6754(@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6755
6756@item @code{positive-time-to-live}
6757@itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
6758A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
6759negative lookup result remains in cache.
6760
6761@item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
6762Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
6763@var{database}.
6764
6765For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
6766instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
6767them into account.
6768
6769@item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
6770Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
6771
6772@item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
6773Whether the cache should be shared among users.
6774
6775@item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
6776Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
6777
6778@c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
6779@c settings, so leave them out.
6780
6781@end table
6782@end deftp
6783
6784@defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
6785List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
6786@code{nscd-configuration} (see above.)
6787
6788It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
6789lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
6790resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
6791privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
6792external name servers do not even need to be queried.
6793@end defvr
6794
6795
be1c2c54 6796@deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service [#:config-file #f]
1bb76f75
AK
6797Return a service that runs @code{syslogd}. If configuration file name
6798@var{config-file} is not specified, use some reasonable default
cf4a9129
LC
6799settings.
6800@end deffn
401c53c4 6801
0adfe95a
LC
6802@anchor{guix-configuration-type}
6803@deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
6804This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
6805@xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
6806
6807@table @asis
6808@item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
6809The Guix package to use.
401c53c4 6810
0adfe95a
LC
6811@item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
6812Name of the group for build user accounts.
401c53c4 6813
0adfe95a
LC
6814@item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
6815Number of build user accounts to create.
401c53c4 6816
0adfe95a
LC
6817@item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
6818Whether to authorize the substitute key for @code{hydra.gnu.org}
6819(@pxref{Substitutes}).
6820
6821@item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
6822Whether to use substitutes.
6823
b0b9f6e0
LC
6824@item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
6825The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
6826
0adfe95a
LC
6827@item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
6828List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
6829
6830@item @code{lsof} (default: @var{lsof})
6831@itemx @code{lsh} (default: @var{lsh})
6832The lsof and lsh packages to use.
6833
6834@end table
6835@end deftp
6836
6837@deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-service @var{config}
6838Return a service that runs the Guix build daemon according to
6839@var{config}.
cf4a9129 6840@end deffn
a1ba8475 6841
be1c2c54 6842@deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev udev]
cf4a9129
LC
6843Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
6844@end deffn
401c53c4 6845
be1c2c54 6846@deffn {Scheme Procedure} console-keymap-service @var{file}
5eca9459
AK
6847Return a service to load console keymap from @var{file} using
6848@command{loadkeys} command.
6849@end deffn
6850
8664cc88
LC
6851@deffn {Scheme Procedure} gpm-service-type [#:gpm @var{gpm}] @
6852 [#:options]
6853Run @var{gpm}, the general-purpose mouse daemon, with the given
6854command-line @var{options}. GPM allows users to use the mouse in the console,
6855notably to select, copy, and paste text. The default value of @var{options}
6856uses the @code{ps2} protocol, which works for both USB and PS/2 mice.
6857
6858This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
6859@end deffn
6860
1c52181f
LC
6861@anchor{guix-publish-service}
6862@deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-publish-service [#:guix @var{guix}] @
6863 [#:port 80] [#:host "localhost"]
6864Return a service that runs @command{guix publish} listening on @var{host}
6865and @var{port} (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
6866
6867This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
6868created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
6869archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
6870@end deffn
6871
a69576ea 6872
cf4a9129
LC
6873@node Networking Services
6874@subsubsection Networking Services
401c53c4 6875
fa1e31b8 6876The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
cf4a9129 6877the network interface.
a1ba8475 6878
a023cca8 6879@cindex DHCP, networking service
be1c2c54 6880@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcp-client-service [#:dhcp @var{isc-dhcp}]
a023cca8
LC
6881Return a service that runs @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
6882Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces.
6883@end deffn
6884
be1c2c54 6885@deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
cf4a9129
LC
6886 [#:gateway #f] [#:name-services @code{'()}]
6887Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
6888@var{gateway} is true, it must be a string specifying the default network
6889gateway.
6890@end deffn
8b315a6d 6891
b7d0c494 6892@cindex wicd
87f40011 6893@cindex network management
be1c2c54 6894@deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
87f40011
LC
6895Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
6896management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
6897
6898This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
6899several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
6900@command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
6901and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
b7d0c494
MW
6902@end deffn
6903
c0a9589d
SB
6904@cindex NetworkManager
6905@deffn {Scheme Procedure} network-manager-service @
6906 [#:network-manager @var{network-manager}]
6907Return a service that runs NetworkManager, a network connection manager
6908that attempting to keep active network connectivity when available.
6909@end deffn
6910
be1c2c54 6911@deffn {Scheme Procedure} ntp-service [#:ntp @var{ntp}] @
63854bcb
LC
6912 [#:name-service @var{%ntp-servers}]
6913Return a service that runs the daemon from @var{ntp}, the
6914@uref{http://www.ntp.org, Network Time Protocol package}. The daemon will
6915keep the system clock synchronized with that of @var{servers}.
6916@end deffn
6917
6918@defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
6919List of host names used as the default NTP servers.
6920@end defvr
6921
375c6108
LC
6922@deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-service [@var{config-file}] [#:tor @var{tor}]
6923Return a service to run the @uref{https://torproject.org, Tor} anonymous
6924networking daemon.
8b315a6d 6925
375c6108 6926The daemon runs as the @code{tor} unprivileged user. It is passed
6331bde7
LC
6927@var{config-file}, a file-like object, with an additional @code{User tor} line
6928and lines for hidden services added via @code{tor-hidden-service}. Run
6929@command{man tor} for information about the configuration file.
6930@end deffn
6931
24a8ef3b 6932@cindex hidden service
6331bde7
LC
6933@deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
6934Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
6935@var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
6936
6937@example
24a8ef3b
LC
6938 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
6939 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
6331bde7
LC
6940@end example
6941
6942In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
6943port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
6944
6629099a
LC
6945This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
6946the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
6331bde7
LC
6947service.
6948
6949See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
6950project's documentation} for more information.
cf4a9129 6951@end deffn
8b315a6d 6952
be1c2c54 6953@deffn {Scheme Procedure} bitlbee-service [#:bitlbee bitlbee] @
4627a464
LC
6954 [#:interface "127.0.0.1"] [#:port 6667] @
6955 [#:extra-settings ""]
6956Return a service that runs @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee}, a daemon that
6957acts as a gateway between IRC and chat networks.
6958
6959The daemon will listen to the interface corresponding to the IP address
6960specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}. @code{127.0.0.1} means that only
6961local clients can connect, whereas @code{0.0.0.0} means that connections can
6962come from any networking interface.
6963
6964In addition, @var{extra-settings} specifies a string to append to the
6965configuration file.
6966@end deffn
6967
f4391bec 6968Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following service.
8b315a6d 6969
be1c2c54 6970@deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
5833bf33 6971 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
cf4a9129
LC
6972 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
6973 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
6974 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
21cc905a 6975 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
cf4a9129
LC
6976Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
6977@var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
6978only by root.
72e25e35 6979
5833bf33
DP
6980When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
6981controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
6982@var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
6983depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
6984@command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
6985
cf4a9129
LC
6986When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
6987upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
6988require interaction.
8b315a6d 6989
20dd519c
LC
6990When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
6991randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
6992a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
6993basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
6994
cf4a9129
LC
6995When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
6996network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
6997or addresses.
9bf3c1a7 6998
20dd519c
LC
6999@var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
7000passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
cf4a9129 7001root.
4af2447e 7002
cf4a9129
LC
7003The other options should be self-descriptive.
7004@end deffn
4af2447e 7005
fa0c1d61
LC
7006@defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
7007This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
7008(@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
7009line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
7010on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
7011host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
7012
7013This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
7313a52e
LC
7014@code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
7015@file{/etc/hosts}}):
fa0c1d61
LC
7016
7017@example
7018(use-modules (gnu) (guix))
7019
7020(operating-system
7021 (host-name "mymachine")
7022 ;; ...
7023 (hosts-file
7024 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
7025 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
24e02c28
LC
7026 (plain-file "hosts"
7027 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
7028 %facebook-host-aliases))))
fa0c1d61
LC
7029@end example
7030
7031This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
7032browsers, from accessing Facebook.
7033@end defvr
7034
965a7332
LC
7035The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
7036
be1c2c54 7037@deffn {Scheme Procedure} avahi-service [#:avahi @var{avahi}] @
965a7332
LC
7038 [#:host-name #f] [#:publish? #t] [#:ipv4? #t] @
7039 [#:ipv6? #t] [#:wide-area? #f] @
7040 [#:domains-to-browse '()]
7041Return a service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
7042mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
cc9c1f39
LC
7043"zero-configuration" host name lookups (see @uref{http://avahi.org/}), and
7044extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can resolve
7045@code{.local} host names using
1065bed9
LC
7046@uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. Additionally,
7047add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that commands such as
7048@command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
965a7332
LC
7049
7050If @var{host-name} is different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
7051publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
7052
7053When @var{publish?} is true, publishing of host names and services is allowed;
7054in particular, avahi-daemon will publish the machine's host name and IP
7055address via mDNS on the local network.
7056
7057When @var{wide-area?} is true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
7058
7059Boolean values @var{ipv4?} and @var{ipv6?} determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6
7060sockets.
7061@end deffn
7062
7063
cf4a9129
LC
7064@node X Window
7065@subsubsection X Window
68ad877c 7066
cf4a9129
LC
7067Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
7068Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
7069there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
7070started by the @dfn{login manager}, currently SLiM.
4af2447e 7071
be1c2c54 7072@deffn {Scheme Procedure} slim-service [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] @
0ecc3bf3
LC
7073 [#:auto-login? #f] [#:default-user ""] [#:startx] @
7074 [#:theme @var{%default-slim-theme}] @
4bd43bbe 7075 [#:theme-name @var{%default-slim-theme-name}]
cf4a9129
LC
7076Return a service that spawns the SLiM graphical login manager, which in
7077turn starts the X display server with @var{startx}, a command as returned by
7078@code{xorg-start-command}.
4af2447e 7079
04e4e6ab
LC
7080@cindex X session
7081
7082SLiM automatically looks for session types described by the @file{.desktop}
7083files in @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users
7084to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. Packages such as
7085@var{xfce}, @var{sawfish}, and @var{ratpoison} provide @file{.desktop} files;
7086adding them to the system-wide set of packages automatically makes them
7087available at the log-in screen.
7088
7089In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
7090@file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
7091and/or other X clients.
7092
cf4a9129
LC
7093When @var{allow-empty-passwords?} is true, allow logins with an empty
7094password. When @var{auto-login?} is true, log in automatically as
7095@var{default-user}.
0ecc3bf3
LC
7096
7097If @var{theme} is @code{#f}, the use the default log-in theme; otherwise
7098@var{theme} must be a gexp denoting the name of a directory containing the
7099theme to use. In that case, @var{theme-name} specifies the name of the
7100theme.
cf4a9129 7101@end deffn
4af2447e 7102
0ecc3bf3
LC
7103@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
7104@defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
7105The G-Expression denoting the default SLiM theme and its name.
7106@end defvr
7107
be1c2c54 7108@deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [#:guile] @
d1cdd7ba 7109 [#:configuration-file #f] [#:xorg-server @var{xorg-server}]
f703413e 7110Return a derivation that builds a @var{guile} script to start the X server
d1cdd7ba
LC
7111from @var{xorg-server}. @var{configuration-file} is the server configuration
7112file or a derivation that builds it; when omitted, the result of
7113@code{xorg-configuration-file} is used.
7114
7115Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
7116@end deffn
7117
be1c2c54 7118@deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-configuration-file @
12422c9d 7119 [#:drivers '()] [#:resolutions '()] [#:extra-config '()]
d1cdd7ba
LC
7120Return a configuration file for the Xorg server containing search paths for
7121all the common drivers.
f703413e
LC
7122
7123@var{drivers} must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a
7124graphics driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in
d1cdd7ba 7125this order---e.g., @code{(\"modesetting\" \"vesa\")}.
d2e59637
LC
7126
7127Likewise, when @var{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an
7128appropriate screen resolution; otherwise, it must be a list of
7129resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024 768) (640 480))}.
12422c9d
LC
7130
7131Last, @var{extra-config} is a list of strings or objects appended to the
7132@code{text-file*} argument list. It is used to pass extra text to be added
7133verbatim to the configuration file.
f703413e 7134@end deffn
4af2447e 7135
6726282b
LC
7136@deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{name}]
7137Add @var{package}, a package for a screen-locker or screen-saver whose
7138command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
7139for it. For example:
7140
7141@lisp
7142(screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
7143@end lisp
7144
7145makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
7146@end deffn
7147
7148
fe1a39d3
LC
7149@node Desktop Services
7150@subsubsection Desktop Services
aa4ed923 7151
fe1a39d3
LC
7152The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
7153usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
7154machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
7155interfaces, etc.
aa4ed923 7156
4467be21
LC
7157To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
7158services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
7159environment and networking:
7160
7161@defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
7162This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
7163adds or adjust services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
7164
7165In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
6726282b
LC
7166@code{slim-service}}), screen lockers,
7167a network management tool (@pxref{Networking
4467be21 7168Services, @code{wicd-service}}), energy and color management services,
4650a77e 7169the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the Polkit privilege service,
cee32ee4
AW
7170the GeoClue location service, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking
7171Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the name service switch service
7172configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service
7173Switch, mDNS}).
4467be21
LC
7174@end defvr
7175
7176The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
7177field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
7178Reference, @code{services}}).
7179
0adfe95a
LC
7180The actual service definitions provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)}
7181and @code{(gnu services desktop)} are described below.
4467be21 7182
0adfe95a 7183@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
fe1a39d3
LC
7184Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
7185support for @var{services}.
aa4ed923 7186
fe1a39d3
LC
7187@uref{http://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
7188facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
7189and be notified of system-wide events.
aa4ed923 7190
fe1a39d3
LC
7191@var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
7192@file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
7193and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
7194@var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
aa4ed923
AK
7195@end deffn
7196
0adfe95a 7197@deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
4650a77e
AW
7198Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
7199seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/andywingo/elogind,
7200Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
7201are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
7202system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
7203
7204Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
7205example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
7206when the power button is pressed.
7207
7208The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
7209elogind, and should be the result of a @code{(elogind-configuration
7210(@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
7211their default values are:
7212
7213@table @code
7214@item kill-user-processes?
7215@code{#f}
7216@item kill-only-users
7217@code{()}
7218@item kill-exclude-users
7219@code{("root")}
7220@item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
7221@code{5}
7222@item handle-power-key
7223@code{poweroff}
7224@item handle-suspend-key
7225@code{suspend}
7226@item handle-hibernate-key
7227@code{hibernate}
7228@item handle-lid-switch
7229@code{suspend}
7230@item handle-lid-switch-docked
7231@code{ignore}
7232@item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
7233@code{#f}
7234@item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
7235@code{#f}
7236@item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
7237@code{#f}
7238@item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
7239@code{#t}
7240@item holdoff-timeout-seconds
7241@code{30}
7242@item idle-action
7243@code{ignore}
7244@item idle-action-seconds
7245@code{(* 30 60)}
7246@item runtime-directory-size-percent
7247@code{10}
7248@item runtime-directory-size
7249@code{#f}
7250@item remove-ipc?
7251@code{#t}
7252@item suspend-state
7253@code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
7254@item suspend-mode
7255@code{()}
7256@item hibernate-state
7257@code{("disk")}
7258@item hibernate-mode
7259@code{("platform" "shutdown")}
7260@item hybrid-sleep-state
7261@code{("disk")}
7262@item hybrid-sleep-mode
7263@code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
7264@end table
7265@end deffn
7266
be1c2c54 7267@deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
4650a77e 7268 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
222e3319
LC
7269Return a service that runs the
7270@uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
7271management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
7272privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
7273privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
7274capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
7275the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
4650a77e
AW
7276@end deffn
7277
be1c2c54 7278@deffn {Scheme Procedure} upower-service [#:upower @var{upower}] @
be234128
AW
7279 [#:watts-up-pro? #f] @
7280 [#:poll-batteries? #t] @
7281 [#:ignore-lid? #f] @
7282 [#:use-percentage-for-policy? #f] @
7283 [#:percentage-low 10] @
7284 [#:percentage-critical 3] @
7285 [#:percentage-action 2] @
7286 [#:time-low 1200] @
7287 [#:time-critical 300] @
7288 [#:time-action 120] @
7289 [#:critical-power-action 'hybrid-sleep]
7290Return a service that runs @uref{http://upower.freedesktop.org/,
7291@command{upowerd}}, a system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery
7292levels, with the given configuration settings. It implements the
7293@code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is notably used by
7294GNOME.
7295@end deffn
7296
2b9e0a94
LC
7297@deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
7298Return a service for @uref{http://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
7299UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
7300notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
7301include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
7302@end deffn
7303
be1c2c54 7304@deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
7ce597ff
AW
7305Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
7306interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
7307screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
7308tool. See @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
7309site} for more information.
7310@end deffn
7311
cee32ee4
AW
7312@deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
7313Return an configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
7314location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
7315the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
7316will have access to location information by default. The boolean
7317@var{system?} value indicates that an application is a system component
7318or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
7319this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
7320means that all users are allowed.
7321@end deffn
7322
7323@defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
7324The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
7325granting authority to GNOME's date-and-time utility to ask for the
7326current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the Firefox
7327(IceCat) and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
7328Firefox and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
7329know the user's location.
7330@end defvr
7331
be1c2c54 7332@deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
cee32ee4
AW
7333 [#:whitelist '()] @
7334 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
7335 [#:submit-data? #f]
7336 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
7337 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
7338 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
7339Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
7340provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
7341user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
7342location databases. See
7343@uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
7344web site} for more information.
7345@end deffn
7346
105369a4
DT
7347@node Database Services
7348@subsubsection Database Services
7349
7350The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following service.
7351
be1c2c54 7352@deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
105369a4
DT
7353 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data'']
7354Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
7355server.
7356
7357The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from
7358@var{config-file} and stores the database cluster in
7359@var{data-directory}.
7360@end deffn
fe1a39d3 7361
d8c18af8
AW
7362@node Mail Services
7363@subsubsection Mail Services
7364
7365The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
7366for mail services. Currently the only implemented service is Dovecot,
7367an IMAP, POP3, and LMTP server.
7368
7369Guix does not yet have a mail transfer agent (MTA), although for some
7370lightweight purposes the @code{esmtp} relay-only MTA may suffice. Help
7371is needed to properly integrate a full MTA, such as Postfix. Patches
7372welcome!
7373
7374To add an IMAP/POP3 server to a GuixSD system, add a
7375@code{dovecot-service} to the operating system definition:
7376
7377@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
7378Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
7379@end deffn
7380
7381By default, Dovecot doesn't need much configuration; the default
7382configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
7383suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
7384certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
7385Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
7386number of options though which mail administrators might need to change,
7387and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
7388administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
7389
7390For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
7391one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
7392
7393@example
7394(dovecot-service #:config
7395 (dovecot-configuration
7396 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
7397@end example
7398
7399The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
7400definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
7401indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
7402strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
7403if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
7404from some other system; see the end for more details.
7405
7406@c The following documentation was initially generated by
7407@c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
7408@c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
7409@c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
7410@c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
7411@c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
7412@c the churn as dovecot updates.
7413
7414Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
7415
7416@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
7417The dovecot package.
7418@end deftypevr
7419
7420@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
7421A list of IPs or hosts where to listen in for connections. @samp{*}
7422listens in all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens in all IPv6
7423interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
7424complex, customize the address and port fields of the
7425@samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
7426@end deftypevr
7427
7428@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
7429List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
7430@samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
7431
7432Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
7433
7434@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
7435The name of the protocol.
7436@end deftypevr
7437
7438@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
7439UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
7440This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
7441Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
7442@end deftypevr
7443
7444@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
7445Space separated list of plugins to load.
7446@end deftypevr
7447
7448@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
7449Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
7450address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
7451Defaults to @samp{10}.
7452@end deftypevr
7453
7454@end deftypevr
7455
7456@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
7457List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
7458@samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
7459@samp{lmtp}.
7460
7461Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
7462
7463@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
7464The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
7465@code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
7466@code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
7467@code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
7468@end deftypevr
7469
7470@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
7471Listeners for the service. A listener is either an
7472@code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
7473an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
7474Defaults to @samp{()}.
7475
7476Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
7477
7478@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
7479The file name on which to listen.
7480@end deftypevr
7481
7482@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
7483The access mode for the socket.
7484Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
7485@end deftypevr
7486
7487@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
f9b9a033 7488The user to own the socket.
d8c18af8
AW
7489Defaults to @samp{""}.
7490@end deftypevr
7491
7492@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
7493The group to own the socket.
7494Defaults to @samp{""}.
7495@end deftypevr
7496
7497
7498Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
7499
7500@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
7501The file name on which to listen.
7502@end deftypevr
7503
7504@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
7505The access mode for the socket.
7506Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
7507@end deftypevr
7508
7509@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
f9b9a033 7510The user to own the socket.
d8c18af8
AW
7511Defaults to @samp{""}.
7512@end deftypevr
7513
7514@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
7515The group to own the socket.
7516Defaults to @samp{""}.
7517@end deftypevr
7518
7519
7520Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
7521
7522@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
7523The protocol to listen for.
7524@end deftypevr
7525
7526@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
7527The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
7528Defaults to @samp{""}.
7529@end deftypevr
7530
7531@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
7532The port on which to listen.
7533@end deftypevr
7534
7535@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
7536Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
7537@samp{required}.
7538Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7539@end deftypevr
7540
7541@end deftypevr
7542
7543@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
7544Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
7545Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
7546secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
7547Defaults to @samp{1}.
7548@end deftypevr
7549
7550@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
7551Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
7552Defaults to @samp{0}.
7553@end deftypevr
7554
7555@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
7556If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
7557this.
7558Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
7559@end deftypevr
7560
7561@end deftypevr
7562
7563@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
7564Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
7565constructor.
7566
7567Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
7568
7569@deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
7570A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
7571Defaults to @samp{()}.
7572@end deftypevr
7573
7574@end deftypevr
7575
7576@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
7577List of passdb configurations, each one created by the
7578@code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
7579
7580Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
7581
7582@deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
7583The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
7584@samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
7585@samp{static}.
7586Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
7587@end deftypevr
7588
7589@deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
7590A list of key-value args to the passdb driver.
7591Defaults to @samp{()}.
7592@end deftypevr
7593
7594@end deftypevr
7595
7596@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
7597List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
7598@code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
7599
7600Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
7601
7602@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
7603The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
7604@samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
7605Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
7606@end deftypevr
7607
7608@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
7609A list of key-value args to the userdb driver.
7610Defaults to @samp{()}.
7611@end deftypevr
7612
7613@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
7614Override fields from passwd.
7615Defaults to @samp{()}.
7616@end deftypevr
7617
7618@end deftypevr
7619
7620@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
7621Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
7622constructor.
7623@end deftypevr
7624
7625@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
7626List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
7627@code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
7628
7629Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
7630
7631@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
7632Name for this namespace.
7633@end deftypevr
7634
7635@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
7636Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
7637Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
7638@end deftypevr
7639
7640@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
7641Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
7642all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
7643one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
7644format.
7645Defaults to @samp{""}.
7646@end deftypevr
7647
7648@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
7649Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
7650different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
7651Defaults to @samp{""}.
7652@end deftypevr
7653
7654@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
7655Physical location of the mailbox. This is in same format as
7656mail_location, which is also the default for it.
7657Defaults to @samp{""}.
7658@end deftypevr
7659
7660@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
7661There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
7662namespace has it.
7663Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7664@end deftypevr
7665
7666@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
7667If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
7668extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
7669useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
7670which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
7671create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
7672and @samp{mail/}.
7673Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7674@end deftypevr
7675
7676@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
7677Show the mailboxes under this namespace with LIST command. This
7678makes the namespace visible for clients that don't support NAMESPACE
7679extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
7680hides the namespace prefix.
7681Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7682@end deftypevr
7683
7684@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
7685Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
7686parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
7687as @code{#t}.)
7688Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7689@end deftypevr
7690
7691@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
7692List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
7693Defaults to @samp{()}.
7694
7695Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
7696
7697@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
7698Name for this mailbox.
7699@end deftypevr
7700
7701@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
7702@samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
7703@samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
7704Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
7705@end deftypevr
7706
7707@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
7708List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
7709Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
7710@code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
7711Defaults to @samp{()}.
7712@end deftypevr
7713
7714@end deftypevr
7715
7716@end deftypevr
7717
7718@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
7719Base directory where to store runtime data.
7720Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
7721@end deftypevr
7722
7723@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
7724Greeting message for clients.
7725Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
7726@end deftypevr
7727
7728@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
7729List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
7730allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
7731authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
7732for these networks. Typically you'd specify your IMAP proxy servers
7733here.
7734Defaults to @samp{()}.
7735@end deftypevr
7736
7737@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
7738List of login access check sockets (e.g. tcpwrap).
7739Defaults to @samp{()}.
7740@end deftypevr
7741
7742@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
7743Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
7744and IP address. Useful for seeing who are actually using the IMAP
7745processes (e.g. shared mailboxes or if same uid is used for multiple
7746accounts).
7747Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7748@end deftypevr
7749
7750@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
7751Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
7752Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
7753forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
7754be a problem if the upgrade is e.g. because of a security fix).
7755Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7756@end deftypevr
7757
7758@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
7759If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
7760server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
7761Defaults to @samp{0}.
7762@end deftypevr
7763
7764@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
7765UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
7766Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
7767@end deftypevr
7768
7769@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
7770List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
7771and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
7772key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
7773@end deftypevr
7774
7775@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
7776Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
7777SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
7778matches the local IP (i.e. you're connecting from the same computer),
7779the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
7780allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
7781Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7782@end deftypevr
7783
7784@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
7785Authentication cache size (e.g. @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
7786Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
7787for caching to be used.
7788Defaults to @samp{0}.
7789@end deftypevr
7790
7791@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
7792Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
7793is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
7794failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
7795user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
7796cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
7797authentication.
7798Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
7799@end deftypevr
7800
7801@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
7802TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
78030 disables caching them completely.
7804Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
7805@end deftypevr
7806
7807@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
7808List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
7809You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
7810Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
7811realm first.
7812Defaults to @samp{()}.
7813@end deftypevr
7814
7815@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
7816Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
7817both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
7818logins.
7819Defaults to @samp{""}.
7820@end deftypevr
7821
7822@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
7823List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
7824contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
7825This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
7826potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
7827you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
7828Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
7829@end deftypevr
7830
7831@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
7832Username character translations before it's looked up from
7833databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
7834example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
7835translated to @samp{@@}.
7836Defaults to @samp{""}.
7837@end deftypevr
7838
7839@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
7840Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
7841use the standard variables here, e.g. %Lu would lowercase the username,
7842%n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
7843change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
7844@samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
7845Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
7846@end deftypevr
7847
7848@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
7849If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
7850username within the normal username string (i.e. not using SASL
7851mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
7852here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
7853UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
7854choice.
7855Defaults to @samp{""}.
7856@end deftypevr
7857
7858@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
7859Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
7860mechanism.
7861Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
7862@end deftypevr
7863
7864@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
7865Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
7866execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g. MySQL and PAM).
7867They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
7868Defaults to @samp{30}.
7869@end deftypevr
7870
7871@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
7872Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
7873the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
7874allow all keytab entries.
7875Defaults to @samp{""}.
7876@end deftypevr
7877
7878@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
7879Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
7880system default (usually /etc/krb5.keytab) if not specified. You may
7881need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
7882file.
7883Defaults to @samp{""}.
7884@end deftypevr
7885
7886@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
7887Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
7888and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
7889<doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
7890Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7891@end deftypevr
7892
7893@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
7894Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
7895Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
7896@end deftypevr
7897
7898@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
7899Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
7900Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
7901@end deftypevr
7902
7903@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
7904Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
7905fails.
7906Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7907@end deftypevr
7908
7909@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
7910Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
7911@code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
7912CommonName.
7913Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7914@end deftypevr
7915
7916@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
7917List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
7918@samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
7919@samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
7920@samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
7921@samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
7922@end deftypevr
7923
7924@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
7925List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
7926Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
7927director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
7928Defaults to @samp{()}.
7929@end deftypevr
7930
7931@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
7932List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
7933allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
7934Defaults to @samp{()}.
7935@end deftypevr
7936
7937@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
7938How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
7939has any connections.
7940Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
7941@end deftypevr
7942
7943@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer director-doveadm-port
7944TCP/IP port that accepts doveadm connections (instead of director
7945connections) If you enable this, you'll also need to add
7946@samp{inet-listener} for the port.
7947Defaults to @samp{0}.
7948@end deftypevr
7949
7950@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
7951How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
7952include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
7953are shared within domain.
7954Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
7955@end deftypevr
7956
7957@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
7958Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
7959@samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
7960Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
7961@end deftypevr
7962
7963@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
7964Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
7965@samp{log-path}.
7966Defaults to @samp{""}.
7967@end deftypevr
7968
7969@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
7970Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
7971@samp{info-log-path}.
7972Defaults to @samp{""}.
7973@end deftypevr
7974
7975@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
7976Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
7977don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
7978standard facilities are supported.
7979Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
7980@end deftypevr
7981
7982@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
7983Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
7984failed.
7985Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7986@end deftypevr
7987
7988@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
7989In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
7990values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
7991force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
7992and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
7993":n" (e.g. sha1:6).
7994Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7995@end deftypevr
7996
7997@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
7998Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
7999SQL queries.
8000Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8001@end deftypevr
8002
8003@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
8004In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
8005the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
8006@samp{auth-debug}.
8007Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8008@end deftypevr
8009
8010@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
8011Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
8012Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
8013Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8014@end deftypevr
8015
8016@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
8017Show protocol level SSL errors.
8018Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8019@end deftypevr
8020
8021@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
8022Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
8023strftime(3) format.
8024Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
8025@end deftypevr
8026
8027@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
8028List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
8029non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
8030string.
8031@end deftypevr
8032
8033@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
8034Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
8035string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
8036Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
8037@end deftypevr
8038
8039@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
8040Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
8041of possible variables you can use.
8042Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u): \""}.
8043@end deftypevr
8044
8045@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
8046Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
8047@table @code
8048@item %$
8049Delivery status message (e.g. @samp{saved to INBOX})
8050@item %m
8051Message-ID
8052@item %s
8053Subject
8054@item %f
8055From address
8056@item %p
8057Physical size
8058@item %w
8059Virtual size.
8060@end table
8061Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
8062@end deftypevr
8063
8064@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
8065Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
8066that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
8067if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
8068Dovecot the full location.
8069
8070If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
8071file (e.g. /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
8072where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
8073directory", and it must be the first path given in the
8074@samp{mail-location} setting.
8075
8076There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
8077
8078@table @samp
8079@item %u
8080username
8081@item %n
8082user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
8083@item %d
8084domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
8085@item %h
8086home director
8087@end table
8088
8089See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
8090@table @samp
8091@item maildir:~/Maildir
8092@item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
8093@item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
8094@end table
8095Defaults to @samp{""}.
8096@end deftypevr
8097
8098@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
8099System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
8100userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
8101either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
8102Defaults to @samp{""}.
8103@end deftypevr
8104
8105@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
8106
8107Defaults to @samp{""}.
8108@end deftypevr
8109
8110@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
8111Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
8112this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
8113dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
8114/var/mail.
8115Defaults to @samp{""}.
8116@end deftypevr
8117
8118@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
8119Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
8120Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
8121that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
8122symlinks (e.g. if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
8123could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
8124/secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
8125Defaults to @samp{""}.
8126@end deftypevr
8127
8128@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
8129Allow full filesystem access to clients. There's no access checks
8130other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
8131works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
8132names with e.g. /path/ or ~user/.
8133Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8134@end deftypevr
8135
8136@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
8137Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
8138shared filesystems (NFS or clustered filesystem).
8139Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8140@end deftypevr
8141
8142@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
8143Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
8144supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
8145nowadays by default.
8146Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8147@end deftypevr
8148
8149@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
8150When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
8151@table @code
8152@item optimized
8153Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
8154@item always
8155Useful with e.g. NFS when write()s are delayed
8156@item never
8157Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
8158@end table
8159Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
8160@end deftypevr
8161
8162@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
8163Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
8164NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
8165this isn't needed.
8166Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8167@end deftypevr
8168
8169@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
8170Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
8171@samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
8172Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8173@end deftypevr
8174
8175@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
8176Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
8177dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
8178than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
8179change @samp{mmap-disable}.
8180Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
8181@end deftypevr
8182
8183@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
8184Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
8185kB.
8186Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
8187@end deftypevr
8188
8189@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
8190Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
8191log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
8192hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
8193is set to 0.
8194Defaults to @samp{500}.
8195@end deftypevr
8196
8197@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
8198
8199Defaults to @samp{0}.
8200@end deftypevr
8201
8202@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
8203Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
8204aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
8205non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
8206Defaults to @samp{1}.
8207@end deftypevr
8208
8209@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
8210
8211Defaults to @samp{0}.
8212@end deftypevr
8213
8214@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
8215Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
8216trying to create new keywords.
8217Defaults to @samp{50}.
8218@end deftypevr
8219
8220@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
8221List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
8222processes (i.e. /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
8223too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
8224@samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
8225"/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
8226which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
8227this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
8228<doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
8229Defaults to @samp{()}.
8230@end deftypevr
8231
8232@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
8233Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
8234for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
8235directory (e.g. /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
8236there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
8237access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
8238directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/." to
8239@samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
8240Defaults to @samp{""}.
8241@end deftypevr
8242
8243@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
8244UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
8245This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
8246Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
8247@end deftypevr
8248
8249@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
8250Directory where to look up mail plugins.
8251Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
8252@end deftypevr
8253
8254@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
8255List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
8256LDA, etc. are added to this list in their own .conf files.
8257Defaults to @samp{()}.
8258@end deftypevr
8259
8260@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
8261The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
8262cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
8263writes at the cost of more disk reads.
8264Defaults to @samp{0}.
8265@end deftypevr
8266
8267@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
8268When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
8269see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
8270the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
8271dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
8272occur.
8273Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
8274@end deftypevr
8275
8276@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
8277Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
8278mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
8279FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
8280slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
8281they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
8282Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8283@end deftypevr
8284
8285@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
8286By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
8287with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
8288which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
8289causes more disk I/O.
8290 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
8291and it's done always regardless of this setting).
8292Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8293@end deftypevr
8294
8295@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
8296When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
8297This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
8298side effects.
8299Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8300@end deftypevr
8301
8302@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
8303Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
8304directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
8305the mail otherwise.
8306Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8307@end deftypevr
8308
8309@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
8310Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
8311available:
8312
8313@table @code
8314@item dotlock
8315Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
8316solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
8317need write access to that directory.
8318@item dotlock-try
8319Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
8320isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
8321@item fcntl
8322Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
8323@item flock
8324May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
8325@item lockf
8326May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
8327@end table
8328
8329You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
8330in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
8331locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
8332them simultaneously.
8333@end deftypevr
8334
8335@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
8336
8337@end deftypevr
8338
8339@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
8340Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
8341Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
8342@end deftypevr
8343
8344@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
8345If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
8346override the lock file after this much time.
8347Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
8348@end deftypevr
8349
8350@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
8351When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
8352what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
8353the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
8354simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
8355this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
8356whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
8357downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
8358flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
8359done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
8360Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8361@end deftypevr
8362
8363@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
8364Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
8365EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
8366@samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
8367Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8368@end deftypevr
8369
8370@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
8371Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
8372and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
8373useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
8374that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
8375Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8376@end deftypevr
8377
8378@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
8379If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g. 100k), don't write index
8380files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
8381updated.
8382Defaults to @samp{0}.
8383@end deftypevr
8384
8385@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
8386Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
8387Defaults to @samp{2000000}.
8388@end deftypevr
8389
8390@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
8391Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
8392begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
8393disabled.
8394Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
8395@end deftypevr
8396
8397@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
8398When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
8399@samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
8400with some filesystems (ext4, xfs).
8401Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8402@end deftypevr
8403
8404@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
8405sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
8406which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
8407don't support this for now.
8408
8409WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
8410
8411Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
8412Defaults to @samp{""}.
8413@end deftypevr
8414
8415@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
8416Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
8417possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
8418externally.
8419Defaults to @samp{128000}.
8420@end deftypevr
8421
8422@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
8423Filesystem backend to use for saving attachments:
8424@table @code
8425@item posix
8426No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
8427@item sis posix
8428SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
8429@item sis-queue posix
8430SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
8431@end table
8432Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
8433@end deftypevr
8434
8435@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
8436Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
8437variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
8438@code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
8439truncated, e.g. @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
8440Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
8441@end deftypevr
8442
8443@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
8444
8445Defaults to @samp{100}.
8446@end deftypevr
8447
8448@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
8449
8450Defaults to @samp{1000}.
8451@end deftypevr
8452
8453@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
8454Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
8455This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
8456before they eat up everything.
8457Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
8458@end deftypevr
8459
8460@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
8461Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
8462untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
8463at all.
8464Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
8465@end deftypevr
8466
8467@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
8468Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
8469separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
8470processes.
8471Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
8472@end deftypevr
8473
8474@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
8475SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
8476Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
8477@end deftypevr
8478
8479@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
8480PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
8481Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
8482@end deftypevr
8483
8484@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
8485PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
8486dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
8487root.
8488Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
8489@end deftypevr
8490
8491@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
8492If key file is password protected, give the password here.
8493Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
8494this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
8495instead to a different.
8496Defaults to @samp{""}.
8497@end deftypevr
8498
8499@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
8500PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
8501intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
8502contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
8503CRL(s). (e.g. @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
8504Defaults to @samp{""}.
8505@end deftypevr
8506
8507@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
8508Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
8509Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8510@end deftypevr
8511
8512@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
8513Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
8514it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
8515Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8516@end deftypevr
8517
8518@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
8519Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
8520x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
8521@samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
8522Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
8523@end deftypevr
8524
8525@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} hours ssl-parameters-regenerate
8526How often to regenerate the SSL parameters file. Generation is
8527quite CPU intensive operation. The value is in hours, 0 disables
8528regeneration entirely.
8529Defaults to @samp{168}.
8530@end deftypevr
8531
8532@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-protocols
8533SSL protocols to use.
8534Defaults to @samp{"!SSLv2"}.
8535@end deftypevr
8536
8537@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
8538SSL ciphers to use.
8539Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!LOW:!SSLv2:!EXP:!aNULL"}.
8540@end deftypevr
8541
8542@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
8543SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
8544Defaults to @samp{""}.
8545@end deftypevr
8546
8547@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
8548Address to use when sending rejection mails.
8549Default is postmaster@@<your domain>. %d expands to recipient domain.
8550Defaults to @samp{""}.
8551@end deftypevr
8552
8553@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
8554Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g. in Message-Id)
8555and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
8556Defaults to @samp{""}.
8557@end deftypevr
8558
8559@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
8560If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
8561bouncing the mail.
8562Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8563@end deftypevr
8564
8565@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
8566Binary to use for sending mails.
8567Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
8568@end deftypevr
8569
8570@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
8571If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
8572sendmail.
8573Defaults to @samp{""}.
8574@end deftypevr
8575
8576@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
8577Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
8578variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
8579Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
8580@end deftypevr
8581
8582@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
8583Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
8584variables:
8585
8586@table @code
8587@item %n
8588CRLF
8589@item %r
8590reason
8591@item %s
8592original subject
8593@item %t
8594recipient
8595@end table
8596Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
8597@end deftypevr
8598
8599@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
8600Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
8601address.
8602Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
8603@end deftypevr
8604
8605@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
8606Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
8607address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
8608parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
8609X-Original-To.
8610Defaults to @samp{""}.
8611@end deftypevr
8612
8613@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
8614Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
8615it?.
8616Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8617@end deftypevr
8618
8619@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
8620Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
8621subscribed?.
8622Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8623@end deftypevr
8624
8625@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
8626Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
8627command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
8628get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
8629often.
8630Defaults to @samp{64000}.
8631@end deftypevr
8632
8633@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
8634IMAP logout format string:
8635@table @code
8636@item %i
8637total number of bytes read from client
8638@item %o
8639total number of bytes sent to client.
8640@end table
8641Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o"}.
8642@end deftypevr
8643
8644@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
8645Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
8646add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g. +XFOO XBAR).
8647Defaults to @samp{""}.
8648@end deftypevr
8649
8650@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
8651How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
8652is IDLEing.
8653Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
8654@end deftypevr
8655
8656@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
8657ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
8658makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
8659values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
8660support-email.
8661Defaults to @samp{""}.
8662@end deftypevr
8663
8664@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
8665ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
8666Defaults to @samp{""}.
8667@end deftypevr
8668
8669@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
8670Workarounds for various client bugs:
8671
8672@table @code
8673@item delay-newmail
8674Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
8675CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
8676Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
8677may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
8678still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
8679"Headers Only".
8680
8681@item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
8682Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
8683adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
8684ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
8685
8686@item tb-lsub-flags
8687Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g. mbox).
8688This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
8689greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
8690@end table
8691Defaults to @samp{()}.
8692@end deftypevr
8693
8694@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
8695Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
8696Defaults to @samp{""}.
8697@end deftypevr
8698
8699
8700Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
8701that GuixSD has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
8702language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
8703but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
8704inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
8705
8706However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
8707and running. In that case, you can pass an
8708@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} paramter to
8709@code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
8710does not have easy reflective capabilities.
8711
8712Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
8713
8714@deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
8715The dovecot package.
8716@end deftypevr
8717
8718@deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
8719The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
8720@end deftypevr
8721
8722For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
8723could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
8724
8725@example
8726(dovecot-service #:config
8727 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
8728 (string "")))
8729@end example
8730
58724c48
DT
8731@node Web Services
8732@subsubsection Web Services
8733
8734The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the following service:
8735
be1c2c54 8736@deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-service [#:nginx nginx] @
58724c48
DT
8737 [#:log-directory ``/var/log/nginx''] @
8738 [#:run-directory ``/var/run/nginx''] @
8739 [#:config-file]
8740
8741Return a service that runs @var{nginx}, the nginx web server.
8742
8743The nginx daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file}.
8744Log files are written to @var{log-directory} and temporary runtime data
8745files are written to @var{run-directory}. For proper operation, these
8746arguments should match what is in @var{config-file} to ensure that the
8747directories are created when the service is activated.
8748
8749@end deffn
8750
fe1a39d3
LC
8751@node Various Services
8752@subsubsection Various Services
8753
8754The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
8755
be1c2c54 8756@deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
fe1a39d3
LC
8757 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
8758 [#:extra-options '()]
8759Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
8760decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
8761
8762Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
8763(configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
8764for details.
8765
8766Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
8767passed to @command{lircd}.
8768@end deffn
8769
8770
0ae8c15a
LC
8771@node Setuid Programs
8772@subsection Setuid Programs
8773
8774@cindex setuid programs
8775Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
8776launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
4d40227c
LC
8777@command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
8778password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
0ae8c15a
LC
8779@file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
8780obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
8781@dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
8782(@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
f7e4ae7f 8783for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
0ae8c15a
LC
8784
8785The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
8786security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
8787populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
8788used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
8789the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
8790should be setuid root.
8791
8792The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
8793declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
8794programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
8795For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
8796package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
8797
8798@example
8799#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
8800@end example
8801
8802A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
8803@code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
8804
8805@defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
8806A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
8807
8808The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
8809@command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
8810@end defvr
8811
8812Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
8813@file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
8814files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
8815store.
8816
efb5e833
LC
8817@node X.509 Certificates
8818@subsection X.509 Certificates
8819
8820@cindex HTTPS, certificates
8821@cindex X.509 certificates
8822@cindex TLS
8823Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
8824security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
8825that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
8826that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
8827so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
8828signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
8829
8830Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
8831certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
8832out-of-the-box.
8833
8834However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
8835@command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
8836certificates can be found.
8837
8838@cindex @code{nss-certs}
8839In GuixSD, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
8840to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
8841(@pxref{operating-system Reference}). GuixSD includes one such package,
8842@code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
8843Mozilla's Network Security Services.
8844
8845Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
8846explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
8847most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
8848to the certificates installed globally.
8849
8850Unprivileged users can also install their own certificate package in
8851their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
8852that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
8853OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
8854variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
8855instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
8856pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable.
8857
8858
996ed739
LC
8859@node Name Service Switch
8860@subsection Name Service Switch
8861
8862@cindex name service switch
8863@cindex NSS
8864The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
8865configuration file of libc's @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
8866(@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
8867Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
8868extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
8869includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
8870Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
8871C Library Reference Manual}).
8872
8873The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
8874method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
8875together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
8876next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
8877@code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
8878(@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
8879
4c9050c6
LC
8880@cindex nss-mdns
8881@cindex .local, host name lookup
996ed739 8882As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
4c9050c6
LC
8883@uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
8884back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
8885for host names ending in @code{.local}:
996ed739
LC
8886
8887@example
8888(name-service-switch
8889 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
8890
8891 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
8892 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
8893 (name-service
8894 (name "mdns_minimal")
8895
8896 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
8897 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
8898 ;; no need to try the next methods.
8899 (reaction (lookup-specification
8900 (not-found => return))))
8901
8902 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
8903 (name-service
8904 (name "dns"))
8905
8906 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
8907 (name-service
8908 (name "mdns")))))
8909@end example
8910
15137a29
LC
8911Don't worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
8912contains this configuration, so you won't have to type it if all you
8913want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
8914
4c9050c6
LC
8915Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
8916@code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
cc9c1f39
LC
8917you also need to use @code{avahi-service} (@pxref{Networking Services,
8918@code{avahi-service}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
8919(@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
8920to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
8921@code{nscd-service}}).
15137a29
LC
8922
8923For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
8924configurations.
8925
8926@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
8927This is the default name service switch configuration, a
8928@code{name-service-switch} object.
8929@end defvr
8930
8931@defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
8932This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
8933lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
8934@end defvr
4c9050c6 8935
996ed739
LC
8936The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
8937is a direct mapping of the C library's configuration file format, so
8938please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
8939Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
8940Compared to libc's NSS configuration file format, it has the advantage
8941not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
8942static checks: you'll know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
8943run @command{guix system}.
8944
996ed739
LC
8945@deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
8946
8947This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
8948service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
8949system databases.
8950
8951@table @code
8952@item aliases
8953@itemx ethers
8954@itemx group
8955@itemx gshadow
8956@itemx hosts
8957@itemx initgroups
8958@itemx netgroup
8959@itemx networks
8960@itemx password
8961@itemx public-key
8962@itemx rpc
8963@itemx services
8964@itemx shadow
8965The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
8966list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below.)
8967@end table
8968@end deftp
8969
8970@deftp {Data Type} name-service
8971
8972This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
8973associated lookup action.
8974
8975@table @code
8976@item name
8977A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
8978configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
8979
4aee6e60
LC
8980Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
8981achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
8982@code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
8983services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
8984
996ed739
LC
8985@item reaction
8986An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
8987(@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
8988Reference Manual}). For example:
8989
8990@example
8991(lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
8992 (success => return))
8993@end example
8994@end table
8995@end deftp
0ae8c15a 8996
fd1b1fa2
LC
8997@node Initial RAM Disk
8998@subsection Initial RAM Disk
8999
9000@cindex initial RAM disk (initrd)
9001@cindex initrd (initial RAM disk)
9002For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
9003@dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
9004root file system, as well as an initialization script. The latter is
9005responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
9006kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
9007
9008The @code{initrd} field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
9009you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
9010system linux-initrd)} module provides two ways to build an initrd: the
9011high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure, and the low-level
9012@code{expression->initrd} procedure.
9013
9014The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
9015For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
9016at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
9017system declaration like this:
9018
9019@example
52ac153e 9020(initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
027981d6
LC
9021 ;; Create a standard initrd that has modules "foo.ko"
9022 ;; and "bar.ko", as well as their dependencies, in
9023 ;; addition to the modules available by default.
52ac153e 9024 (apply base-initrd file-systems
027981d6 9025 #:extra-modules '("foo" "bar")
52ac153e 9026 rest)))
fd1b1fa2
LC
9027@end example
9028
52ac153e
LC
9029The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
9030involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system whose
9031root file system is volatile.
fd1b1fa2 9032
e90cf6c1
LC
9033The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} honors several
9034options passed on the Linux kernel command line (that is, arguments
9035passed @i{via} GRUB's @code{linux} command, or with QEMU's
9036@code{-append} option), notably:
9037
9038@table @code
9039@item --load=@var{boot}
9040Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
9041program, once it has mounted the root file system.
9042
9043GuixSD uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
dd17bc38 9044service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
e90cf6c1
LC
9045initialization system.
9046
9047@item --root=@var{root}
9048Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
9049device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a partition label, or a partition
9050UUID.
9051
9052@item --system=@var{system}
9053Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
9054@var{system}.
9055
9056@item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
9057@cindex module, black-listing
9058@cindex black list, of kernel modules
9059Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
9060(from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
9061must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
9062@code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
9063
9064@item --repl
9065Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
9066tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
9067marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
9068love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
9069Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
9070
9071@end table
9072
9073Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
9074@code{base-initrd} provide, here is how to use it and customize it
9075further.
9076
fd1b1fa2 9077@deffn {Monadic Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
9059b97d 9078 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:virtio? #t] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
52ac153e 9079 [#:extra-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()]
fd1b1fa2
LC
9080Return a monadic derivation that builds a generic initrd. @var{file-systems} is
9081a list of file-systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
9082the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
52ac153e
LC
9083@var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
9084@var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
fd1b1fa2
LC
9085
9086When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
9087parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so the initrd can
9088be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
9089
9090When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
9091to it are lost.
9092
9093The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
9094for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. However, additional kernel
9095modules can be listed in @var{extra-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
9096loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
9097@end deffn
9098
9099Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
9100statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
9101program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
9102@code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
9103program to run in that initrd.
9104
9105@deffn {Monadic Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
9106 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"] @
42d10464 9107 [#:modules '()]
fd1b1fa2
LC
9108Return a derivation that builds a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
9109containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
df650fa8
LC
9110upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
9111automatically copied to the initrd.
fd1b1fa2 9112
42d10464
LC
9113@var{modules} is a list of Guile module names to be embedded in the
9114initrd.
fd1b1fa2
LC
9115@end deffn
9116
88faf933
LC
9117@node GRUB Configuration
9118@subsection GRUB Configuration
9119
9120@cindex GRUB
9121@cindex boot loader
9122
9123The operating system uses GNU@tie{}GRUB as its boot loader
9124(@pxref{Overview, overview of GRUB,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). It is
9125configured using @code{grub-configuration} declarations. This data type
9126is exported by the @code{(gnu system grub)} module, and described below.
9127
9128@deftp {Data Type} grub-configuration
9129The type of a GRUB configuration declaration.
9130
9131@table @asis
9132
9133@item @code{device}
9134This is a string denoting the boot device. It must be a device name
9135understood by the @command{grub-install} command, such as
9136@code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub,
9137GNU GRUB Manual}).
9138
9139@item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
9140A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
9141entries to appear in the GRUB boot menu, in addition to the current
9142system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
9143
9144@item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
9145The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the current
9146system's entry.
9147
9148@item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
9149The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
91500 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
9151
9152@item @code{theme} (default: @var{%default-theme})
9153The @code{grub-theme} object describing the theme to use.
9154@end table
9155
9156@end deftp
9157
9158Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
9159@code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
9160@code{menu-entry} form:
9161
9162@deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
9163The type of an entry in the GRUB boot menu.
9164
9165@table @asis
9166
9167@item @code{label}
35ed9306 9168The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
88faf933
LC
9169
9170@item @code{linux}
9171The Linux kernel to boot.
9172
9173@item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
9174The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
9175@code{("console=ttyS0")}.
9176
9177@item @code{initrd}
9178A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
9179to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
9180
9181@end table
9182@end deftp
9183
9184@c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
9185Themes are created using the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not
9186documented yet.
9187
9188@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
9189This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system, with a
9190fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix logos.
9191@end defvr
9192
9193
cf4a9129
LC
9194@node Invoking guix system
9195@subsection Invoking @code{guix system}
0918e64a 9196
cf4a9129
LC
9197Once you have written an operating system declaration, as seen in the
9198previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
9199system} command. The synopsis is:
4af2447e 9200
cf4a9129
LC
9201@example
9202guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
9203@end example
4af2447e 9204
cf4a9129
LC
9205@var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
9206@code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
9207operating system is instantiate. Currently the following values are
9208supported:
4af2447e 9209
cf4a9129
LC
9210@table @code
9211@item reconfigure
9212Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
9213switch to it@footnote{This action is usable only on systems already
65797bff 9214running GuixSD.}.
4af2447e 9215
cf4a9129
LC
9216This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
9217accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
240b57f0
LC
9218The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
9219currently running; if a service is currently running, it does not
9220attempt to upgrade it since it would not be possible without stopping it
9221first.
4af2447e 9222
cf4a9129
LC
9223It also adds a GRUB menu entry for the new OS configuration, and moves
9224entries for older configurations to a submenu---unless
9225@option{--no-grub} is passed.
4af2447e 9226
240b57f0 9227@quotation Note
bf2479c7
LC
9228@c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
9229@c <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
9230It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
9231@command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
9232guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
9233once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
240b57f0 9234@end quotation
bf2479c7 9235
cf4a9129
LC
9236@item build
9237Build the operating system's derivation, which includes all the
9238configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
9239This action does not actually install anything.
113daf62 9240
cf4a9129
LC
9241@item init
9242Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
9243operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
4705641f 9244installations of GuixSD. For instance:
113daf62
LC
9245
9246@example
cf4a9129 9247guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
113daf62
LC
9248@end example
9249
cf4a9129
LC
9250copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
9251specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
9252files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
9253needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
9254@file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
113daf62 9255
cf4a9129
LC
9256This command also installs GRUB on the device specified in
9257@file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-grub} option was passed.
113daf62 9258
cf4a9129
LC
9259@item vm
9260@cindex virtual machine
0276f697 9261@cindex VM
f535dcbe 9262@anchor{guix system vm}
cf4a9129
LC
9263Build a virtual machine that contain the operating system declared in
9264@var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
810568b3 9265Arguments given to the script are passed as is to QEMU.
113daf62 9266
cf4a9129 9267The VM shares its store with the host system.
113daf62 9268
0276f697
LC
9269Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
9270the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
9271specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
9272provides read-only access to the shared directory.
9273
9274The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
9275accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
9276read-write mapping of the host's @file{$HOME/tmp}:
9277
9278@example
9279guix system vm my-config.scm \
9280 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
9281@end example
9282
6aa260af
LC
9283On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
9284the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
9285host's store can then be mounted.
9286
9287The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
9288with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
9289containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
9290be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
9291image's size.
ab11f0be 9292
cf4a9129
LC
9293@item vm-image
9294@itemx disk-image
9295Return a virtual machine or disk image of the operating system declared
9296in @var{file} that stands alone. Use the @option{--image-size} option
9297to specify the size of the image.
113daf62 9298
cf4a9129 9299When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
97d76250
LF
9300the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM},
9301for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
113daf62 9302
cf4a9129
LC
9303When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
9304copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
9305the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image on it
9306using the following command:
113daf62 9307
cf4a9129
LC
9308@example
9309# dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
9310@end example
113daf62 9311
1c8a81b1
DT
9312@item container
9313Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
9314within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
9315mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
9316substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
9317the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
9318host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
9319
9320Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
9321a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
9322system.
9323
9324As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
9325systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
9326using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
9327
9328@example
9329guix system container my-config.scm \
9330 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
9331@end example
9332
0f252e26 9333@quotation Note
cfd35b4e 9334This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
0f252e26
DT
9335@end quotation
9336
cf4a9129 9337@end table
113daf62 9338
ccd7158d
LC
9339@var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
9340Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
9341following:
113daf62 9342
cf4a9129
LC
9343@table @option
9344@item --system=@var{system}
9345@itemx -s @var{system}
9346Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host's system type.
9347This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
113daf62 9348
f3f427c2
LC
9349@item --derivation
9350@itemx -d
9351Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
9352building anything.
9353
cf4a9129
LC
9354@item --image-size=@var{size}
9355For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
9356of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
4a44d7bb
LC
9357include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
9358coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
db030303
LC
9359
9360@item --on-error=@var{strategy}
9361Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
9362@var{strategy} may be one of the following:
9363
9364@table @code
9365@item nothing-special
9366Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
9367
9368@item backtrace
9369Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
9370
9371@item debug
9372Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
9373commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
9374display local variable values, and more generally inspect the program's
9375state. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
9376a list of available debugging commands.
9377@end table
113daf62 9378@end table
113daf62 9379
cf4a9129
LC
9380Note that all the actions above, except @code{build} and @code{init},
9381rely on KVM support in the Linux-Libre kernel. Specifically, the
9382machine should have hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
9383KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
9384must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the daemon's
9385build users.
8451a568 9386
65797bff
LC
9387Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
9388your GuixSD installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
9389system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
9390GRUB boot menu:
9391
9392@table @code
9393
9394@item list-generations
9395List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
9396disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
9397@option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
9398(@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
9399
9400Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
9401in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
9402generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
9403generations up to 10-day old:
9404
9405@example
9406$ guix system list-generations 10d
9407@end example
9408
9409@end table
9410
d6c3267a
LC
9411The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
9412sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
9413each other:
9414
9415@anchor{system-extension-graph}
9416@table @code
9417
9418@item extension-graph
9419Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
9420extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
9421(@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
9422extensions.)
9423
9424The command:
9425
9426@example
9427$ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
9428@end example
9429
9430produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
9431
710fa231
AK
9432@anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
9433@item shepherd-graph
6f305ea5 9434Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
dd17bc38
AK
9435graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
9436@var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
9437example graph.
6f305ea5 9438
d6c3267a
LC
9439@end table
9440
97d76250
LF
9441@node Running GuixSD in a VM
9442@subsection Running GuixSD in a virtual machine
9443
9444One way to run GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) is to build a GuixSD
9445virtual machine image using @command{guix system vm-image}
9446(@pxref{Invoking guix system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format,
9447which the @uref{http://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
9448
9449To run the image in QEMU, copy it out of the store (@pxref{The Store})
9450and give yourself permission to write to the copy. When invoking QEMU,
9451you must choose a system emulator that is suitable for your hardware
9452platform. Here is a minimal QEMU invocation that will boot the result
9453of @command{guix system vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
9454
9455@example
9456$ qemu-system-x86_64 \
9457 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
9458 -enable-kvm -m 256 /tmp/qemu-image
9459@end example
9460
9461Here is what each of these options means:
9462
9463@table @code
9464@item qemu-system-x86_64
9465This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
9466host.
9467
9468@item -net user
9469Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
9470access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
9471guest OS online. If you don't choose a network stack, the boot will
9472fail.
9473
9474@item -net nic,model=virtio
9475You must create a network interface of a given model. If you don't
9476create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
9477x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
9478@command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
9479
9480@item -enable-kvm
9481If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
9482Linux kernel's virtual machine support (KVM) will make things run
9483faster.
9484
9485@item -m 256
9486RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
9487which may be insufficent for some operations.
9488
9489@item /tmp/qemu-image
9490The file name of the qcow2 image.
9491@end table
d6c3267a 9492
cf4a9129
LC
9493@node Defining Services
9494@subsection Defining Services
8451a568 9495
eb524192 9496The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
0adfe95a
LC
9497them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
9498them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
8451a568 9499
0adfe95a
LC
9500@menu
9501* Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
9502* Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
9503* Service Reference:: API reference.
dd17bc38 9504* Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
0adfe95a
LC
9505@end menu
9506
9507@node Service Composition
9508@subsubsection Service Composition
9509
9510@cindex services
9511@cindex daemons
9512Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
9513operating system's functionality. Often a service is a process---a
9514@dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
9515Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
9516whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
9517started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
9518@command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
9519daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
9520and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
9521collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
9522daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the system's @file{/etc}
9523directory.
9524
d6c3267a 9525@cindex service extensions
0adfe95a 9526GuixSD services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
dd17bc38
AK
9527secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---GuixSD's
9528initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
9529lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
9530Services, @code{lsh-service}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
9531service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
9532udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
9533Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
9534Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
9535and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
9536user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
0adfe95a
LC
9537
9538All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
9539acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
9540as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
9541
9542@image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
9543
d62e201c
LC
9544@cindex system service
9545At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
9546directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
9547by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
9548to learn about the other service types shown here.
d6c3267a
LC
9549@xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
9550command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
9551particular operating system definition.
0adfe95a
LC
9552
9553@cindex service types
9554Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
9555relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
9556system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
9557shell server (lsh) has two instances of @var{lsh-service-type}, with
9558different parameters.
9559
9560The following section describes the programming interface for service
9561types and services.
9562
9563@node Service Types and Services
9564@subsubsection Service Types and Services
9565
9566A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
9567with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
9568(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
9569
9570@example
9571(define guix-service-type
9572 (service-type
9573 (name 'guix)
9574 (extensions
d4053c71 9575 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
0adfe95a
LC
9576 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
9577 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))))
9578@end example
8451a568 9579
cf4a9129 9580@noindent
0adfe95a
LC
9581It defines a two things:
9582
9583@enumerate
9584@item
9585A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
9586
9587@item
9588A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
9589target service type and a procedure that, given the service's
9590parameters, returns a list of object to extend the service of that type.
9591
9592Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
9593exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
9594@end enumerate
9595
9596In this example, @var{guix-service-type} extends three services:
9597
9598@table @var
d4053c71
AK
9599@item shepherd-root-service-type
9600The @var{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
9601service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
9602object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
9603(@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
0adfe95a
LC
9604
9605@item account-service-type
9606This extension for this service is computed by @var{guix-accounts},
9607which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
9608objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
9609guix-daemon}).
9610
9611@item activation-service-type
9612Here @var{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
9613a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
9614booted.
9615@end table
9616
9617A service of this type is instantiated like this:
9618
9619@example
9620(service guix-service-type
9621 (guix-configuration
9622 (build-accounts 5)
9623 (use-substitutes? #f)))
9624@end example
9625
9626The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
9627the parameters of this specific service instance.
9628@xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
9629information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type.
9630
9631@var{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
9632services but is not extensible itself.
9633
9634@c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
9635
9636The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
9637
9638@example
9639(define udev-service-type
9640 (service-type (name 'udev)
9641 (extensions
d4053c71
AK
9642 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
9643 udev-shepherd-service)))
0adfe95a
LC
9644
9645 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
9646 (extend (lambda (config rules)
9647 (match config
9648 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
9649 (udev-configuration
9650 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
9651 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
9652@end example
9653
9654This is the service type for the
9655@uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
9656management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
d4053c71 9657extension of @var{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
0adfe95a
LC
9658
9659@table @code
9660@item compose
9661This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
9662services of this type.
9663
9664Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
9665compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
9666
9667@item extend
9668This procedure defines how the service's value is @dfn{extended} with
9669the composition of the extensions.
9670
9671Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
9672value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
9673extend that record by appending the list of rules is contains to the
9674list of contributed rules.
9675@end table
9676
9677There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
9678@var{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
9679@code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
9680
9681Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
9682interface for services.
9683
9684@node Service Reference
9685@subsubsection Service Reference
9686
9687We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
9688Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
9689services and service types. This interface is provided by the
9690@code{(gnu services)} module.
9691
9692@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} @var{value}
9693Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
9694below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
9695this particular service instance.
9696@end deffn
9697
9698@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
9699Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
9700@end deffn
8451a568 9701
0adfe95a
LC
9702@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
9703Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
9704@end deffn
9705
9706@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-parameters @var{service}
9707Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
9708parameters.
9709@end deffn
9710
9711Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
9712
9713@example
9714(define s
9715 (service nginx-service-type
9716 (nginx-configuration
9717 (nginx nginx)
9718 (log-directory log-directory)
9719 (run-directory run-directory)
9720 (file config-file))))
9721
9722(service? s)
9723@result{} #t
9724
9725(eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
9726@result{} #t
9727@end example
9728
cd6f6c22
LC
9729The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
9730parameters of some of the services of a list such as
9731@var{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). Of
9732course, you could always use standard list combinators such as
9733@code{map} and @code{fold} to do that (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,,
9734guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); @code{modify-services} simply
9735provides a more concise form for this common pattern.
9736
9737@deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
9738 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
9739
9740Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
9741clauses. Each clause has the form:
9742
9743@example
9744(@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
9745@end example
9746
9747where @var{type} is a service type, such as @var{guix-service-type}, and
9748@var{variable} is an identifier that is bound within @var{body} to the
9749value of the service of that @var{type}. @xref{Using the Configuration
9750System}, for an example.
9751
9752This is a shorthand for:
9753
9754@example
9755(map (lambda (service) @dots{}) @var{services})
9756@end example
9757@end deffn
9758
9759Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
9760something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
9761necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
9762@code{operating-system} declaration.
9763
0adfe95a
LC
9764@deftp {Data Type} service-type
9765@cindex service type
9766This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
9767and Services}).
9768
9769@table @asis
9770@item @code{name}
9771This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
9772
9773@item @code{extensions}
9774A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below.)
9775
9776@item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
9777If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
9778be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
9779services.
9780
9781Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
9782by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
9783extensions. It must return a value that is a valid parameter value for
9784the service instance.
9785
9786@item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
9787If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
9788
9789Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
9790calls it, passing it the service's initial value as the first argument
9791and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension values as the
9792second argument.
9793@end table
9794
9795@xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
9796@end deftp
9797
9798@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
9799 @var{compute}
9800Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
9801@var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
9802calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
9803the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
9804@end deffn
9805
9806@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
9807Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
9808@end deffn
9809
9810At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
9811procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
d62e201c
LC
9812down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
9813run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
9814command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
9815service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
9816on the way, until it reaches the root node.
0adfe95a
LC
9817
9818@deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
d62e201c 9819 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
0adfe95a
LC
9820Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
9821type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
9822@end deffn
9823
9824Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
9825service types, some of which are listed below.
9826
d62e201c
LC
9827@defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
9828This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
9829as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
9830@end defvr
9831
0adfe95a 9832@defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
d62e201c
LC
9833The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
9834The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
0adfe95a
LC
9835@end defvr
9836
9837@defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
9838The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service can be extended by
9839passing it name/file tuples such as:
9840
9841@example
9842(list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
9843@end example
9844
9845In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
9846pointing to the given file.
9847@end defvr
9848
9849@defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
9850Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
9851executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
9852setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
9853@end defvr
9854
af4c3fd5
LC
9855@defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
9856Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
9857programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
9858extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
9859@end defvr
9860
0adfe95a 9861
dd17bc38
AK
9862@node Shepherd Services
9863@subsubsection Shepherd Services
0adfe95a
LC
9864
9865@cindex PID 1
9866@cindex init system
0190c1c0
AK
9867The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} provides a way to define services
9868managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is GuixSD initialization
9869system---the first process that is started when the system boots,
9870aka. PID@tie{}1 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
9871Manual}).
6f305ea5 9872
dd17bc38
AK
9873Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
9874SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
9875started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
9876been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
9877the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
6f305ea5 9878
710fa231 9879@image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
6f305ea5
LC
9880
9881You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
710fa231
AK
9882definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
9883(@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
6f305ea5 9884
d4053c71
AK
9885The @var{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
9886PID@tie{}1, of type @var{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
9887by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
0adfe95a 9888
d4053c71 9889@deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
dd17bc38 9890The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
0adfe95a
LC
9891
9892@table @asis
9893@item @code{provision}
9894This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
9895
dd17bc38
AK
9896These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
9897@command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
9898shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
9899@code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
0adfe95a
LC
9900
9901@item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
dd17bc38 9902List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
0adfe95a
LC
9903
9904@item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
9905Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
9906underlying process dies.
9907
9908@item @code{start}
9909@itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
dd17bc38
AK
9910The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
9911facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
9912Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
9913G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
9914(@pxref{G-Expressions}).
0adfe95a
LC
9915
9916@item @code{documentation}
9917A documentation string, as shown when running:
9918
9919@example
dd17bc38 9920herd doc @var{service-name}
0adfe95a
LC
9921@end example
9922
9923where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @var{provision}
dd17bc38 9924(@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
fae685b9
LC
9925
9926@item @code{modules} (default: @var{%default-modules})
9927This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
9928@code{stop} are evaluated.
9929
9930@item @code{imported-modules} (default: @var{%default-imported-modules})
9931This is the list of modules to import in the execution environment of
dd17bc38 9932the Shepherd.
fae685b9 9933
0adfe95a
LC
9934@end table
9935@end deftp
9936
d4053c71 9937@defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
dd17bc38 9938The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
0adfe95a
LC
9939
9940This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
dd17bc38 9941shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
d4053c71 9942Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
0adfe95a
LC
9943@end defvr
9944
d4053c71 9945@defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
0adfe95a
LC
9946This service represents PID@tie{}1.
9947@end defvr
8451a568 9948
8451a568 9949
cf4a9129
LC
9950@node Installing Debugging Files
9951@section Installing Debugging Files
8451a568 9952
cf4a9129
LC
9953@cindex debugging files
9954Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
9955typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
9956@dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
9957debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
9958debug a compiled program in good conditions.
8451a568 9959
cf4a9129
LC
9960The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
9961of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
9962weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
9963debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
9964Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
9965debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
9966for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
8451a568 9967
cf4a9129
LC
9968Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
9969mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
9970information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
9971files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
9972when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
9973with GDB}).
8451a568 9974
cf4a9129
LC
9975The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
9976information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
9977output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
9978Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
9979of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
9980installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
9981Guile:
8451a568
LC
9982
9983@example
cf4a9129 9984guix package -i glibc:debug guile:debug
8451a568
LC
9985@end example
9986
cf4a9129
LC
9987GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
9988setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
9989from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
9990GDB}):
8451a568 9991
cf4a9129
LC
9992@example
9993(gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
9994@end example
8451a568 9995
cf4a9129
LC
9996From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
9997@code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
8451a568 9998
cf4a9129
LC
9999In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
10000code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
10001code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
10002--source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
10003directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
10004@code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
8451a568 10005
cf4a9129
LC
10006@c XXX: keep me up-to-date
10007The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
10008@code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
10009opt-in---debugging information is available only for those packages
10010whose definition explicitly declares a @code{debug} output. This may be
10011changed to opt-out in the future, if our build farm servers can handle
10012the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
10013@command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
8451a568 10014
8451a568 10015
05962f29
LC
10016@node Security Updates
10017@section Security Updates
10018
843858b8
LC
10019@quotation Note
10020As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described in this section is
10021experimental.
10022@end quotation
05962f29
LC
10023
10024@cindex security updates
10025Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in core
10026software packages and must be patched. Guix follows a functional
10027package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
10028that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
10029must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
10030fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
10031distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
10032(@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
10033desired.
10034
10035@cindex grafts
10036To address that, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
10037for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
10038with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
10039package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
10040explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
10041the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
10042order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
10043
10044@cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
10045For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
10046Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
10047Bash, say @var{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
10048Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
10049@code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
10050
10051@example
10052(define bash
10053 (package
10054 (name "bash")
10055 ;; @dots{}
10056 (replacement bash-fixed)))
10057@end example
10058
10059From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash that
10060is installed will automatically be ``rewritten'' to refer to
10061@var{bash-fixed} instead of @var{bash}. This grafting process takes
10062time proportional to the size of the package, but expect less than a
10063minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine.
10064
10065Currently, the graft and the package it replaces (@var{bash-fixed} and
10066@var{bash} in the example above) must have the exact same @code{name}
10067and @code{version} fields. This restriction mostly comes from the fact
10068that grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
10069Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
10070package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
10071replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
10072
10073
cf4a9129
LC
10074@node Package Modules
10075@section Package Modules
8451a568 10076
cf4a9129
LC
10077From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
10078GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
10079@dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
10080packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
10081packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
10082naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
10083as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
10084define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
10085Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
10086module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
10087@code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
113daf62 10088
300868ba 10089The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
cf4a9129
LC
10090automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
10091instance, when running @code{guix package -i emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
10092packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
10093object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
10094facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
113daf62 10095
300868ba 10096@cindex customization, of packages
8689901f 10097@cindex package module search path
cf4a9129 10098Users can store package definitions in modules with different
60142854 10099names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
c95ded7e
LC
10100name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
10101emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
10102relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
10103@code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
10104guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. These package definitions
300868ba
LC
10105will not be visible by default. Thus, users can invoke commands such as
10106@command{guix package} and @command{guix build} have to be used with the
c95ded7e
LC
10107@code{-e} option so that they know where to find the package. Better
10108yet, they can use the
300868ba 10109@code{-L} option of these commands to make those modules visible
8689901f
LC
10110(@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--load-path}}), or define the
10111@code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} environment variable. This environment
10112variable makes it easy to extend or customize the distribution and is
10113honored by all the user interfaces.
10114
10115@defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
10116This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for package
10117modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence over the
10118distribution's own modules.
10119@end defvr
ef5dd60a 10120
cf4a9129
LC
10121The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
10122each package is built based solely on other packages in the
10123distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
10124@dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
10125bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
081145cf 10126@pxref{Bootstrapping}.
ef5dd60a 10127
cf4a9129
LC
10128@node Packaging Guidelines
10129@section Packaging Guidelines
ef5dd60a 10130
cf4a9129
LC
10131The GNU distribution is nascent and may well lack some of your favorite
10132packages. This section describes how you can help make the distribution
10133grow. @xref{Contributing}, for additional information on how you can
10134help.
ef5dd60a 10135
cf4a9129
LC
10136Free software packages are usually distributed in the form of
10137@dfn{source code tarballs}---typically @file{tar.gz} files that contain
10138all the source files. Adding a package to the distribution means
10139essentially two things: adding a @dfn{recipe} that describes how to
10140build the package, including a list of other packages required to build
10141it, and adding @dfn{package meta-data} along with that recipe, such as a
10142description and licensing information.
ef5dd60a 10143
cf4a9129
LC
10144In Guix all this information is embodied in @dfn{package definitions}.
10145Package definitions provide a high-level view of the package. They are
10146written using the syntax of the Scheme programming language; in fact,
10147for each package we define a variable bound to the package definition,
10148and export that variable from a module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10149However, in-depth Scheme knowledge is @emph{not} a prerequisite for
10150creating packages. For more information on package definitions,
081145cf 10151@pxref{Defining Packages}.
ef5dd60a 10152
cf4a9129
LC
10153Once a package definition is in place, stored in a file in the Guix
10154source tree, it can be tested using the @command{guix build} command
10155(@pxref{Invoking guix build}). For example, assuming the new package is
c71979f4
LC
10156called @code{gnew}, you may run this command from the Guix build tree
10157(@pxref{Running Guix Before It Is Installed}):
ef5dd60a
LC
10158
10159@example
cf4a9129 10160./pre-inst-env guix build gnew --keep-failed
ef5dd60a 10161@end example
ef5dd60a 10162
cf4a9129
LC
10163Using @code{--keep-failed} makes it easier to debug build failures since
10164it provides access to the failed build tree. Another useful
10165command-line option when debugging is @code{--log-file}, to access the
10166build log.
ef5dd60a 10167
cf4a9129
LC
10168If the package is unknown to the @command{guix} command, it may be that
10169the source file contains a syntax error, or lacks a @code{define-public}
10170clause to export the package variable. To figure it out, you may load
10171the module from Guile to get more information about the actual error:
ef5dd60a 10172
cf4a9129
LC
10173@example
10174./pre-inst-env guile -c '(use-modules (gnu packages gnew))'
10175@end example
ef5dd60a 10176
cf4a9129
LC
10177Once your package builds correctly, please send us a patch
10178(@pxref{Contributing}). Well, if you need help, we will be happy to
10179help you too. Once the patch is committed in the Guix repository, the
10180new package automatically gets built on the supported platforms by
2b1cee21 10181@url{http://hydra.gnu.org/jobset/gnu/master, our continuous integration
cf4a9129 10182system}.
ef5dd60a 10183
cf4a9129
LC
10184@cindex substituter
10185Users can obtain the new package definition simply by running
10186@command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). When
10187@code{hydra.gnu.org} is done building the package, installing the
10188package automatically downloads binaries from there
10189(@pxref{Substitutes}). The only place where human intervention is
10190needed is to review and apply the patch.
ef5dd60a 10191
ef5dd60a 10192
cf4a9129 10193@menu
ec0339cd
LC
10194* Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
10195* Package Naming:: What's in a name?
10196* Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
cbd02397 10197* Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
ec0339cd
LC
10198* Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
10199* Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
10200* Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
cf4a9129 10201@end menu
ef5dd60a 10202
cf4a9129
LC
10203@node Software Freedom
10204@subsection Software Freedom
ef5dd60a 10205
cf4a9129 10206@c Adapted from http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/philosophy.html.
c11a6eb1 10207
cf4a9129
LC
10208The GNU operating system has been developed so that users can have
10209freedom in their computing. GNU is @dfn{free software}, meaning that
10210users have the @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,four
10211essential freedoms}: to run the program, to study and change the program
10212in source code form, to redistribute exact copies, and to distribute
10213modified versions. Packages found in the GNU distribution provide only
10214software that conveys these four freedoms.
c11a6eb1 10215
cf4a9129
LC
10216In addition, the GNU distribution follow the
10217@url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-system-distribution-guidelines.html,free
10218software distribution guidelines}. Among other things, these guidelines
10219reject non-free firmware, recommendations of non-free software, and
10220discuss ways to deal with trademarks and patents.
ef5dd60a 10221
cf4a9129
LC
10222Some packages contain a small and optional subset that violates the
10223above guidelines, for instance because this subset is itself non-free
10224code. When that happens, the offending items are removed with
10225appropriate patches or code snippets in the package definition's
10226@code{origin} form (@pxref{Defining Packages}). That way, @code{guix
10227build --source} returns the ``freed'' source rather than the unmodified
10228upstream source.
ef5dd60a 10229
ef5dd60a 10230
cf4a9129
LC
10231@node Package Naming
10232@subsection Package Naming
ef5dd60a 10233
cf4a9129
LC
10234A package has actually two names associated with it:
10235First, there is the name of the @emph{Scheme variable}, the one following
10236@code{define-public}. By this name, the package can be made known in the
10237Scheme code, for instance as input to another package. Second, there is
10238the string in the @code{name} field of a package definition. This name
10239is used by package management commands such as
10240@command{guix package} and @command{guix build}.
ef5dd60a 10241
cf4a9129
LC
10242Both are usually the same and correspond to the lowercase conversion of
10243the project name chosen upstream, with underscores replaced with
10244hyphens. For instance, GNUnet is available as @code{gnunet}, and
10245SDL_net as @code{sdl-net}.
927097ef 10246
cf4a9129 10247We do not add @code{lib} prefixes for library packages, unless these are
081145cf 10248already part of the official project name. But @pxref{Python
cf4a9129
LC
10249Modules} and @ref{Perl Modules} for special rules concerning modules for
10250the Python and Perl languages.
927097ef 10251
1b366ee4 10252Font package names are handled differently, @pxref{Fonts}.
7fec52b7 10253
ef5dd60a 10254
cf4a9129
LC
10255@node Version Numbers
10256@subsection Version Numbers
ef5dd60a 10257
cf4a9129
LC
10258We usually package only the latest version of a given free software
10259project. But sometimes, for instance for incompatible library versions,
10260two (or more) versions of the same package are needed. These require
10261different Scheme variable names. We use the name as defined
10262in @ref{Package Naming}
10263for the most recent version; previous versions use the same name, suffixed
10264by @code{-} and the smallest prefix of the version number that may
10265distinguish the two versions.
ef5dd60a 10266
cf4a9129
LC
10267The name inside the package definition is the same for all versions of a
10268package and does not contain any version number.
ef5dd60a 10269
cf4a9129 10270For instance, the versions 2.24.20 and 3.9.12 of GTK+ may be packaged as follows:
ef5dd60a 10271
cf4a9129
LC
10272@example
10273(define-public gtk+
10274 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10275 (name "gtk+")
10276 (version "3.9.12")
10277 ...))
cf4a9129
LC
10278(define-public gtk+-2
10279 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10280 (name "gtk+")
10281 (version "2.24.20")
10282 ...))
cf4a9129
LC
10283@end example
10284If we also wanted GTK+ 3.8.2, this would be packaged as
10285@example
10286(define-public gtk+-3.8
10287 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10288 (name "gtk+")
10289 (version "3.8.2")
10290 ...))
cf4a9129 10291@end example
ef5dd60a 10292
880d647d
LC
10293@c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2016-01/msg00425.html>,
10294@c for a discussion of what follows.
10295@cindex version number, for VCS snapshots
10296Occasionally, we package snapshots of upstream's version control system
10297(VCS) instead of formal releases. This should remain exceptional,
10298because it is up to upstream developers to clarify what the stable
10299release is. Yet, it is sometimes necessary. So, what should we put in
10300the @code{version} field?
10301
10302Clearly, we need to make the commit identifier of the VCS snapshot
10303visible in the version string, but we also need to make sure that the
10304version string is monotonically increasing so that @command{guix package
10305--upgrade} can determine which version is newer. Since commit
10306identifiers, notably with Git, are not monotonically increasing, we add
10307a revision number that we increase each time we upgrade to a newer
10308snapshot. The resulting version string looks like this:
10309
10310@example
103112.0.11-3.cabba9e
10312 ^ ^ ^
10313 | | `-- upstream commit ID
10314 | |
10315 | `--- Guix package revision
10316 |
10317latest upstream version
10318@end example
10319
10320It is a good idea to strip commit identifiers in the @code{version}
10321field to, say, 7 digits. It avoids an aesthetic annoyance (assuming
10322aesthetics have a role to play here) as well as problems related to OS
10323limits such as the maximum shebang length (127 bytes for the Linux
10324kernel.) It is best to use the full commit identifiers in
10325@code{origin}s, though, to avoid ambiguities.
10326
cbd02397
LC
10327@node Synopses and Descriptions
10328@subsection Synopses and Descriptions
10329
10330As we have seen before, each package in GNU@tie{}Guix includes a
10331synopsis and a description (@pxref{Defining Packages}). Synopses and
10332descriptions are important: They are what @command{guix package
10333--search} searches, and a crucial piece of information to help users
10334determine whether a given package suits their needs. Consequently,
10335packagers should pay attention to what goes into them.
10336
10337Synopses must start with a capital letter and must not end with a
10338period. They must not start with ``a'' or ``the'', which usually does
10339not bring anything; for instance, prefer ``File-frobbing tool'' over ``A
10340tool that frobs files''. The synopsis should say what the package
10341is---e.g., ``Core GNU utilities (file, text, shell)''---or what it is
10342used for---e.g., the synopsis for GNU@tie{}grep is ``Print lines
10343matching a pattern''.
10344
10345Keep in mind that the synopsis must be meaningful for a very wide
10346audience. For example, ``Manipulate alignments in the SAM format''
10347might make sense for a seasoned bioinformatics researcher, but might be
10348fairly unhelpful or even misleading to a non-specialized audience. It
10349is a good idea to come up with a synopsis that gives an idea of the
10350application domain of the package. In this example, this might give
10351something like ``Manipulate nucleotide sequence alignments'', which
10352hopefully gives the user a better idea of whether this is what they are
10353looking for.
10354
10355@cindex Texinfo markup, in package descriptions
10356Descriptions should take between five and ten lines. Use full
10357sentences, and avoid using acronyms without first introducing them.
10358Descriptions can include Texinfo markup, which is useful to introduce
10359ornaments such as @code{@@code} or @code{@@dfn}, bullet lists, or
ba7d6c76
ML
10360hyperlinks (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). However you
10361should be careful when using some characters for example @samp{@@} and
10362curly braces which are the basic special characters in Texinfo
10363(@pxref{Special Characters,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). User interfaces
10364such as @command{guix package --show} take care of rendering it
10365appropriately.
cbd02397
LC
10366
10367Synopses and descriptions are translated by volunteers
10368@uref{http://translationproject.org/domain/guix-packages.html, at the
10369Translation Project} so that as many users as possible can read them in
10370their native language. User interfaces search them and display them in
10371the language specified by the current locale.
10372
10373Translation is a lot of work so, as a packager, please pay even more
10374attention to your synopses and descriptions as every change may entail
ba7d6c76 10375additional work for translators. In order to help them, it is possible
36743e71 10376to make recommendations or instructions visible to them by inserting
ba7d6c76
ML
10377special comments like this (@pxref{xgettext Invocation,,, gettext, GNU
10378Gettext}):
10379
10380@example
10381;; TRANSLATORS: "X11 resize-and-rotate" should not be translated.
10382(description "ARandR is designed to provide a simple visual front end
10383for the X11 resize-and-rotate (RandR) extension. @dots{}")
10384@end example
cbd02397 10385
ef5dd60a 10386
cf4a9129
LC
10387@node Python Modules
10388@subsection Python Modules
ef5dd60a 10389
cf4a9129
LC
10390We currently package Python 2 and Python 3, under the Scheme variable names
10391@code{python-2} and @code{python} as explained in @ref{Version Numbers}.
10392To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages, it
10393seems desirable that the name of a package for a Python module contains
10394the word @code{python}.
ef5dd60a 10395
cf4a9129
LC
10396Some modules are compatible with only one version of Python, others with both.
10397If the package Foo compiles only with Python 3, we name it
10398@code{python-foo}; if it compiles only with Python 2, we name it
10399@code{python2-foo}. If it is compatible with both versions, we create two
10400packages with the corresponding names.
ef5dd60a 10401
cf4a9129
LC
10402If a project already contains the word @code{python}, we drop this;
10403for instance, the module python-dateutil is packaged under the names
10404@code{python-dateutil} and @code{python2-dateutil}.
113daf62 10405
523e4896 10406
cf4a9129
LC
10407@node Perl Modules
10408@subsection Perl Modules
523e4896 10409
cf4a9129
LC
10410Perl programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
10411using the lowercase upstream name.
10412For Perl packages containing a single class, we use the lowercase class name,
10413replace all occurrences of @code{::} by dashes and prepend the prefix
10414@code{perl-}.
10415So the class @code{XML::Parser} becomes @code{perl-xml-parser}.
10416Modules containing several classes keep their lowercase upstream name and
10417are also prepended by @code{perl-}. Such modules tend to have the word
10418@code{perl} somewhere in their name, which gets dropped in favor of the
10419prefix. For instance, @code{libwww-perl} becomes @code{perl-libwww}.
523e4896 10420
523e4896 10421
7fec52b7
AE
10422@node Fonts
10423@subsection Fonts
10424
10425For fonts that are in general not installed by a user for typesetting
10426purposes, or that are distributed as part of a larger software package,
10427we rely on the general packaging rules for software; for instance, this
10428applies to the fonts delivered as part of the X.Org system or fonts that
10429are part of TeX Live.
10430
10431To make it easier for a user to search for fonts, names for other packages
10432containing only fonts are constructed as follows, independently of the
10433upstream package name.
10434
10435The name of a package containing only one font family starts with
10436@code{font-}; it is followed by the foundry name and a dash @code{-}
10437if the foundry is known, and the font family name, in which spaces are
10438replaced by dashes (and as usual, all upper case letters are transformed
10439to lower case).
10440For example, the Gentium font family by SIL is packaged under the name
10441@code{font-sil-gentium}.
10442
10443For a package containing several font families, the name of the collection
10444is used in the place of the font family name.
10445For instance, the Liberation fonts consist of three families,
10446Liberation Sans, Liberation Serif and Liberation Mono.
10447These could be packaged separately under the names
10448@code{font-liberation-sans} and so on; but as they are distributed together
10449under a common name, we prefer to package them together as
10450@code{font-liberation}.
10451
10452In the case where several formats of the same font family or font collection
10453are packaged separately, a short form of the format, prepended by a dash,
10454is added to the package name. We use @code{-ttf} for TrueType fonts,
1b366ee4 10455@code{-otf} for OpenType fonts and @code{-type1} for PostScript Type 1
7fec52b7
AE
10456fonts.
10457
10458
b25937e3 10459
cf4a9129
LC
10460@node Bootstrapping
10461@section Bootstrapping
b25937e3 10462
cf4a9129 10463@c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
b25937e3 10464
cf4a9129 10465@cindex bootstrapping
7889394e 10466
cf4a9129
LC
10467Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
10468``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
10469contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
10470there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
10471get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
10472a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
10473user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
10474a ``regular user''.
72b9d60d 10475
cf4a9129
LC
10476@cindex bootstrap binaries
10477The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
10478GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
10479command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
10480`grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
10481@code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
10482(@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
10483all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
10484Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
10485@dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
72b9d60d 10486
cf4a9129
LC
10487These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
10488re-create them if needed (more on that later).
72b9d60d 10489
cf4a9129 10490@unnumberedsubsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
c79d54fe 10491
cf4a9129
LC
10492@c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
10493@c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
10494@image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
523e4896 10495
cf4a9129
LC
10496The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
10497distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
d33fa0c7
LC
10498packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
10499@command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
10500
10501@example
10502guix graph -t derivation \
10503 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
10504 | dot -Tps > t.ps
10505@end example
10506
10507At this level of detail, things are
cf4a9129
LC
10508slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
10509along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
10510loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
10511tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
10512distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
10513(@pxref{The Store}).
2e7b5cea 10514
cf4a9129
LC
10515But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
10516to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
10517derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
10518builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
10519@code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
10520@file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
10521the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
10522tarball to be unpacked.
fb729425 10523
cf4a9129
LC
10524Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
10525Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
10526is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
10527is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
10528@code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
10529@code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
10530in the store, using the original layout. The
10531@code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
10532write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
10533corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
10534@code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
fb729425 10535
cf4a9129
LC
10536Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
10537derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
10538etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
fb729425 10539
fb729425 10540
cf4a9129 10541@unnumberedsubsec Building the Build Tools
523e4896 10542
cf4a9129
LC
10543Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
10544depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
10545no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
10546the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
10547directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
10548``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
1f6f57df 10549the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
df2ce343 10550
d33fa0c7
LC
10551The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
10552the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
10553individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
10554several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
10555one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
10556package from source. The command:
10557
10558@example
10559guix graph -t bag \
10560 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
10561 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
10562@end example
10563
10564@noindent
10565produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
10566library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
10567suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
10568approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
10569
10570@image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
10571
cf4a9129
LC
10572@c See <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
10573The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
d33fa0c7
LC
10574GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
10575for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
10576built.
523e4896 10577
cf4a9129
LC
10578Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
10579tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
10580used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
10581guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
4af2447e 10582
d33fa0c7
LC
10583From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
10584GCC uses @code{ld}
cf4a9129
LC
10585from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
10586This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
10587the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
4af2447e 10588
cf4a9129
LC
10589And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
10590the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
dd164244
MW
10591variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
10592implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
1f6f57df 10593(@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
4af2447e 10594
4af2447e 10595
cf4a9129 10596@unnumberedsubsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
4af2447e 10597
cf4a9129
LC
10598Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
10599those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
10600automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
10601the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
4af2447e 10602
cf4a9129
LC
10603The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
10604binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
10605of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
4b2615e1 10606
cf4a9129
LC
10607@example
10608guix build bootstrap-tarballs
10609@end example
10610
10611The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
10612@code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
10613this section.
10614
10615Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
10616reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
10617unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
10618significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
10619know.
10620
10621@node Porting
10622@section Porting to a New Platform
10623
10624As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
10625self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
10626binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
10627operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
10628interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
10629not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
10630the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
10631
10632Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
10633When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
10634target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
10635one:
10636
10637@example
10638guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
10639@end example
10640
1c0c417d
LC
10641For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
10642@code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
10643file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
10644@code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
10645taught about the new platform.
10646
cf4a9129 10647Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
1c0c417d
LC
10648to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
10649is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
10650must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
10651bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
10652available locally, and @file{gnu-system.am} has rules do download it for
10653the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
10654as well.
cf4a9129
LC
10655
10656In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
10657extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
10658above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
10659recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
10660configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
10661Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
10662platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
10663reason.
4af2447e 10664
9bf3c1a7 10665@c *********************************************************************
8c01b9d0 10666@include contributing.texi
c78bd12b 10667
568717fd
LC
10668@c *********************************************************************
10669@node Acknowledgments
10670@chapter Acknowledgments
10671
136787cb
LC
10672Guix is based on the @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
10673which was designed and
4c7ac9aa
LC
10674implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
10675the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
568717fd
LC
10676management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
10677package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
10678transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
10679
10680The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
10681an inspiration for Guix.
10682
4c7ac9aa
LC
10683GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
10684number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
10685information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
10686who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
10687providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
10688
10689
568717fd
LC
10690@c *********************************************************************
10691@node GNU Free Documentation License
10692@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
10693
10694@include fdl-1.3.texi
10695
10696@c *********************************************************************
10697@node Concept Index
10698@unnumbered Concept Index
10699@printindex cp
10700
a85b83d2
LC
10701@node Programming Index
10702@unnumbered Programming Index
10703@syncodeindex tp fn
10704@syncodeindex vr fn
568717fd
LC
10705@printindex fn
10706
10707@bye
10708
10709@c Local Variables:
10710@c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
10711@c End: